blob: c9a7fbe2851918f32b09b9f3a6d26020fcc032cd [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauffb89472012-05-14 07:26:56 +02007 2012/05/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - noepoll
456 - nokqueue
457 - nopoll
458 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200460 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200462 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200463 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100464 - tune.maxaccept
465 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200467 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100468 - tune.rcvbuf.client
469 - tune.rcvbuf.server
470 - tune.sndbuf.client
471 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473 * Debugging
474 - debug
475 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476
477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479------------------------------------
480
481chroot <jail dir>
482 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
483 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
484 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
485 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
486 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
487 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200489daemon
490 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
491 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
492 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
493
494gid <number>
495 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
496 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
497 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
498 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500group <group name>
501 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
502 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200504log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
506 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 configured with "log global".
508
509 <address> can be one of:
510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
513 port).
514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
517 port).
518
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100519 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
522 writeable).
523
524 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
527 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
528 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
529
530 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200531 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
532 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
533 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
534 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
535 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
536 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200538 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540log-send-hostname [<string>]
541 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
542 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
543 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
544 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
545 the logs.
546
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000547log-tag <string>
548 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
549 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
550 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
551 running on the same host.
552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553nbproc <number>
554 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
555 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
556 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
557 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
558 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
559
560pidfile <pidfile>
561 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
562 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
563 starting the process. See also "daemon".
564
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200565stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200566 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200567
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
569 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100570 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
572
573 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
574 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
575 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
578
579 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200580 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200581 counters).
582
583 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
584 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100585
586 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
587 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
588 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
589 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
590 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
591 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
592 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
595 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
596 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100597 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats maxconn <connections>
600 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
601 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603uid <number>
604 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
605 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
606 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
607 one. See also "gid" and "user".
608
609ulimit-n <number>
610 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
611 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
612 option.
613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
615 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
616
617 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
618 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
619 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
620 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
621 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
622 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
623 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
624 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
625 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
626 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628user <user name>
629 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
630 See also "uid" and "group".
631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200632node <name>
633 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
634
635 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
636 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
637 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
638 traffic.
639
640description <text>
641 Add a text that describes the instance.
642
643 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
644 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
645 "<" and ">" characters.
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649-----------------------
650
651maxconn <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
653 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
654 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
655 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
656
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200657maxconnrate <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
659 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
660 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
661 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
662 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
663 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
664 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
665 fairness.
666
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100667maxpipes <number>
668 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
669 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
670 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
671 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
672 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
673 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675noepoll
676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
679
680nokqueue
681 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
684
685nopoll
686 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
687 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100688 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
690 "nokqueue".
691
692nosepoll
693 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
694 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
695 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
696
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100697nosplice
698 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
700 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100701 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
703 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
704 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
705 "option splice-response".
706
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200707spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
708 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
709 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
710 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
711 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
712 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
713
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200714tune.bufsize <number>
715 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
716 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
717 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
718 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
719 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
720 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
721 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
722 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200724tune.chksize <number>
725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
729 checks whenever possible.
730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
739 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
740 limit too high.
741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100742tune.maxaccept <number>
743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
744 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
745 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100746 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
748 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100749 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100750 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
751
752tune.maxpollevents <number>
753 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
754 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
755 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
756 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
757 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
758
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200759tune.maxrewrite <number>
760 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
761 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
762 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
763 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
764 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
765 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
766 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
767 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
768 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
769 bufsize.
770
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200771tune.pipesize <number>
772 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
773 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
774 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
775 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
776 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
777 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100779tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
780tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
781 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
782 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
788
789tune.sndbuf.client <number>
790tune.sndbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
792 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
799 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
800 notifying haproxy again.
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033.3. Debugging
804--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805
806debug
807 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
808 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
809 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
810 system startup.
811
812quiet
813 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
814 line argument "-q".
815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008173.4. Userlists
818--------------
819It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
820http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
821it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
822
823userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100824 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
826
827group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100828 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
830 proceeded by "users" keyword.
831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100832user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
833 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
835 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100836 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
837 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100838 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
839 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
840
841
842 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100843 userlist L1
844 group G1 users tiger,scott
845 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100847 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
848 user scott insecure-password elgato
849 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100851 userlist L2
852 group G1
853 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100855 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
856 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
857 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100858
859 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200861
8623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200863----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200864It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
865haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
866pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
867identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
868or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
869Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
870known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
871the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
872process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
873during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
874tables.
875
876peers <peersect>
877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
879
880peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
881 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
882 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
883 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
884 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
885 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
886 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
887
888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
890
891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
893 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
894 across all peers.
895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200896 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100898 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
899 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
900 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902 backend mybackend
903 mode tcp
904 balance roundrobin
905 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
906 stick on src
907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
909 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200910
911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
916 - defaults <name>
917 - frontend <name>
918 - backend <name>
919 - listen <name>
920
921A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
922its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
923section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925
926A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
927connections.
928
929A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
930to forward incoming connections.
931
932A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
933parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100935All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
936'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
937case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
938
939Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
940logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
941proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
942However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
943name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
944
945Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
946and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100947bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
949modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
950arbitrary criteria.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
954--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200956The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
957limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
958they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
959limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200962and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
963with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
964specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100967 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
968------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
969acl - X X X
970appsession - - X X
971backlog X X X -
972balance X - X X
973bind - X X -
974bind-process X X X X
975block - X X X
976capture cookie - X X -
977capture request header - X X -
978capture response header - X X -
979clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
980contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
981cookie X - X X
982default-server X - X X
983default_backend X X X -
984description - X X X
985disabled X X X X
986dispatch - - X X
987enabled X X X X
988errorfile X X X X
989errorloc X X X X
990errorloc302 X X X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100994fullconn X - X X
995grace X X X X
996hash-type X - X X
997http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100998http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200999http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001000http-request - X X X
1001id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001002ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001003log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004maxconn X X X -
1005mode X X X X
1006monitor fail - X X -
1007monitor-net X X X -
1008monitor-uri X X X -
1009option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1010option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1011option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1012option allbackups (*) X - X X
1013option checkcache (*) X - X X
1014option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1015option contstats (*) X X X -
1016option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1017option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1018option forceclose (*) X X X X
1019-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1020option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001021option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001022option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001023option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1024option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1025option httpchk X - X X
1026option httpclose (*) X X X X
1027option httplog X X X X
1028option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1029option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001030option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001031option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1032option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1033option logasap (*) X X X -
1034option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001035option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option nolinger (*) X X X X
1037option originalto X X X X
1038option persist (*) X - X X
1039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option smtpchk X - X X
1042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1044option splice-request (*) X X X X
1045option splice-response (*) X X X X
1046option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1047option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1049option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1050option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1051option tcpka X X X X
1052option tcplog X X X X
1053option transparent (*) X - X X
1054persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1055rate-limit sessions X X X -
1056redirect - X X X
1057redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1058redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1059reqadd - X X X
1060reqallow - X X X
1061reqdel - X X X
1062reqdeny - X X X
1063reqiallow - X X X
1064reqidel - X X X
1065reqideny - X X X
1066reqipass - X X X
1067reqirep - X X X
1068reqisetbe - X X X
1069reqitarpit - X X X
1070reqpass - X X X
1071reqrep - X X X
1072-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1073reqsetbe - X X X
1074reqtarpit - X X X
1075retries X - X X
1076rspadd - X X X
1077rspdel - X X X
1078rspdeny - X X X
1079rspidel - X X X
1080rspideny - X X X
1081rspirep - X X X
1082rsprep - X X X
1083server - - X X
1084source X - X X
1085srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001086stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001087stats auth X - X X
1088stats enable X - X X
1089stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001090stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091stats realm X - X X
1092stats refresh X - X X
1093stats scope X - X X
1094stats show-desc X - X X
1095stats show-legends X - X X
1096stats show-node X - X X
1097stats uri X - X X
1098-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1099stick match - - X X
1100stick on - - X X
1101stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001102stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001104tcp-request connection - X X -
1105tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001106tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001107tcp-response content - - X X
1108tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109timeout check X - X X
1110timeout client X X X -
1111timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1112timeout connect X - X X
1113timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1114timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1115timeout http-request X X X X
1116timeout queue X - X X
1117timeout server X - X X
1118timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001120timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001122unique-id-format X X X -
1123unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001125use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1127 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011304.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1131---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001132
1133This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1134
1135
1136acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1137 Declare or complete an access list.
1138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1139 no | yes | yes | yes
1140 Example:
1141 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1142 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1143 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1149 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1152 no | no | yes | yes
1153 Arguments :
1154 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1155 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1156
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 checked in each cookie value.
1159
1160 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1161 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1162 milliseconds.
1163
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001164 request-learn
1165 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1166 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1167 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1168 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1169 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1170 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1171
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001172 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1173 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1174 data following this prefix.
1175
1176 Example :
1177 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1178
1179 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1180 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1181
1182 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1183 2 modes are currently supported :
1184 - path-parameters :
1185 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1186 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1187 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1188 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1189 - query-string :
1190 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1191 query string.
1192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1194 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1195 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1196 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001197 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1198 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1199 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1201 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1202
1203 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209 Example :
1210 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001212 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1213 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001216backlog <conns>
1217 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1219 yes | yes | yes | no
1220 Arguments :
1221 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1222 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001223 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001224
1225 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1226 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1227 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1228 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1229 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1230 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1231 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1232 backlog parameter.
1233
1234 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1235 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1236 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1237
1238 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1239
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001242balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1245 yes | no | yes | yes
1246 Arguments :
1247 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1248 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1249 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1250 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1251
1252 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1253 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1254 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1255 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001256 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1257 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1258 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1259 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1260 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1261 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1262 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1263 it, so that you don't worry.
1264
1265 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1266 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1267 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1268 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1269 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1270 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1271 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1272 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001274 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1275 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1276 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1277 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1278 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1279 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1280 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1281 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1282
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001283 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1284 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1285 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1286 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001287 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1289 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1290 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1291 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1292 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001293 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1294 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1295 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1296 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1297 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1298 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1301 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1302 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1303 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1304 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1305 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1306 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1307 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1311 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1312 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
1314 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1315 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1316 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1317 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1318 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1319 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1320 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001321 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1322 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1323 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001325 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1326 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1327 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1328 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1329 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1330 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1331 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1332 URIs start with a leading "/".
1333
1334 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1335 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1336 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1337 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001339 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001340 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1341
1342 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001343 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1344 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1345 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1346 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1347 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1348 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1349 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1350 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1351 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1352 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1353 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1354 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1355 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1356 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1357 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1358 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1359 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1360 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1361 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001362
1363 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1364 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1365 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1366 server will receive the request.
1367
1368 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1369 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1370 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1371 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1372 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001373 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1374 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1375 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001377 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1378 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1379 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1380 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1381 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001383 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001384 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1385 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1386 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1387
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001388 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1389 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1390 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1391
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001392 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001393 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1395 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1396 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1397 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1398 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1399 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001400 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001401 used instead.
1402
1403 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1404 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1405 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1406 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1407
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001408 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1409 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1410 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1411
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001412 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001414 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001415 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1416 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001417
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001418 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001419 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001421 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1422 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1423 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
1425 Examples :
1426 balance roundrobin
1427 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001428 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001429 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1430 balance hdr(host)
1431 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001432
1433 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1434 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001436 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001437 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1438 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1439 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1440 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1441
1442 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1443 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1444 defaults to 16 kB.
1445
1446 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1447 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1448
1449 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1450 Round Robin.
1451
1452 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1453 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1454 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1455 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1456
1457 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1458
1459 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001460 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001461 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1462 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1463 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001465 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1466 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001467
1468
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001469bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1470bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1475bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001477bind /<path> [, ...]
1478bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1479bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1480bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001481 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1483 no | yes | yes | no
1484 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001485 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1486 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1487 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1488 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001489 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001490
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001491 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1492 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001493 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1494 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1495 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001496 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1497 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1498 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1499 the range.
1500
1501 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1502 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1503 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1504 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1505 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1506 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1507 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1508 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1509 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001510
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001511 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1512 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1513 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1514 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1515 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1516 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1517 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1518 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1519
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001520 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1521 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1522 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1523 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1524 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1525 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1526 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1527 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001528 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1529 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001530
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001531 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1532 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1533 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1534 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1535 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1536 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001537 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1538 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1539 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1540 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1541 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1542 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1543 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1544 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001545
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001546 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1547 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1548 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1549 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001550
1551 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1552
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001553 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1554 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1555 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1556 simply ignore this.
1557
1558 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1559 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1560 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1561 simply ignore this.
1562
1563 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1564 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1565 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1566 this.
1567
1568 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1569 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1570 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1571 this.
1572
1573 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1574 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1575 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1576 this.
1577
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001578 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1579 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1580 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001581 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001582 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1583 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1584 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1585 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001586 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1587 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001589 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001590 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1591 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1592 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1593 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1594 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1595 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1596 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1597 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1598 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1599 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1600 with front firewalls which would see an established
1601 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1602
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001603 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1604 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1605 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1606 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1607 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1608 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1609 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1610 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1611 This keyword combined with support from external components
1612 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1613 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1614 not even always usable.
1615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001616 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1617 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1618 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1619 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1620 in a frontend.
1621
1622 Example :
1623 listen http_proxy
1624 bind :80,:443
1625 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001626 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001628 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001629 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630
1631
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001632bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1633 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1635 yes | yes | yes | yes
1636 Arguments :
1637 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1638 may be used to override a default value.
1639
1640 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1641 option may be combined with other numbers.
1642
1643 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1644 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1645 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1646 missing from all processes.
1647
1648 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1649 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1650 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1651 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1652
1653 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1654 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1655 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1656 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1657 and 'even' instances.
1658
1659 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1660 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1661 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1662 32.
1663
1664 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1665 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1666
1667 Example :
1668 listen app_ip1
1669 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001670 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001671
1672 listen app_ip2
1673 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001674 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001675
1676 listen management
1677 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001678 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001679
1680 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1681
1682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683block { if | unless } <condition>
1684 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1686 no | yes | yes | yes
1687
1688 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1689 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001690 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001691 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1693 "block" statements per instance.
1694
1695 Example:
1696 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1697 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1698 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1699 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001701 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702
1703
1704capture cookie <name> len <length>
1705 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1707 no | yes | yes | no
1708 Arguments :
1709 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1710 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1711 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1712 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1713 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1714
1715 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1716 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1717 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1718 right if it exceeds <length>.
1719
1720 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1721 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1722 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1723 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1724
1725 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1726 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1727 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1728
1729 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1730 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1731 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1732 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1735
1736 Example:
1737 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1738
1739 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001740 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001741
1742
1743capture request header <name> len <length>
1744 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1746 no | yes | yes | no
1747 Arguments :
1748 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001749 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001750 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1751 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1752 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1753
1754 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1755 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1756 it exceeds <length>.
1757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001758 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001759 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1760 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001761 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1762 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1763 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1764 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001765 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001766 environments to find where the request came from.
1767
1768 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1769 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1770 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1771 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772
1773 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1774 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1775 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1776 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1777
1778 Example:
1779 capture request header Host len 15
1780 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1781 capture request header Referrer len 15
1782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001783 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 about logging.
1785
1786
1787capture response header <name> len <length>
1788 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1790 no | yes | yes | no
1791 Arguments :
1792 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001793 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1795 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1796 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1797
1798 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1799 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1800 it exceeds <length>.
1801
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001802 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001803 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1804 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1805 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001806 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1807 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1808 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1809 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810
1811 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1812 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1813 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1814 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1815
1816 Example:
1817 capture response header Content-length len 9
1818 capture response header Location len 15
1819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001820 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821 about logging.
1822
1823
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001824clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1827 yes | yes | yes | no
1828 Arguments :
1829 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1831 as explained at the top of this document.
1832
1833 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1834 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1835 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1836 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1837 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1838 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1839 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1840 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001841 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1843 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1844
1845 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1847 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1848 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1849 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1850 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1851
1852 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1853 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1854
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001855 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1856 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001859contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001860 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1862 yes | no | yes | yes
1863 Arguments :
1864 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1866 as explained at the top of this document.
1867
1868 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001869 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001870 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1872 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1873 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1874 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1875
1876 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1877 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1878 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1879 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1880 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1881 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1882
1883 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1884 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1885 instead.
1886
1887 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1888 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1889
1890
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001891cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001892 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001893 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1896 yes | no | yes | yes
1897 Arguments :
1898 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1899 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1900 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1901 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1902 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1903 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1904 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1905 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1906 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1907
1908 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1909 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1910 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1911 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1912 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1913 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1914 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1915 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1916 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1917 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1918 "insert" and "prefix".
1919
1920 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001921 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001922
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001923 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001924 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1925 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1926 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1927 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1928 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1929 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1930 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1931 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1932 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1933 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934
1935 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1936 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1937 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1938 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1939 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1940 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1941 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1942 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1943 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1944 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001945 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1946 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1947 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001949 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1950 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1951 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001952 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1953 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1954 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1955 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001956 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1957 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1958 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1961 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1962 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1963 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1964 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1965 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1966 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1967 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1968 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1969
1970 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1971 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1972 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1973 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1974 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1975 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1976 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1977 persistence cookie in the cache.
1978 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1979
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001980 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1981 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1982 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1983 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1984 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1985 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1986 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1987 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1988 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1989 they logout.
1990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001991 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001992 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001993 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1994 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1995 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1996 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1997 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1998 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001999
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002000 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2001 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2002 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2003 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2004 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2005 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2006 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2007 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2008 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2009 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2010 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2011 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2012 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2013 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2014 the site.
2015
2016 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2017 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2018 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2019 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2020 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2021 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2022 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2023 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2024 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2025 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2026 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2027 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2028 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2029 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2030 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2031 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002033 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2034 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2035 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2036 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 Examples :
2039 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2040 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2041 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002042 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002044 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002045 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002048default-server [param*]
2049 Change default options for a server in a backend
2050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2051 yes | no | yes | yes
2052 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002053 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2054 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2055 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2056 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002057
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002058 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002059 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2060
2061 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064default_backend <backend>
2065 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2067 yes | yes | yes | no
2068 Arguments :
2069 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2070
2071 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2072 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2073 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2074 will catch all undetermined requests.
2075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076 Example :
2077
2078 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2079 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2080 default_backend dynamic
2081
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002082 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2083
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085disabled
2086 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2088 yes | yes | yes | yes
2089 Arguments : none
2090
2091 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2092 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2093 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2094 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2095 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2096 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2097 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2098
2099 See also : "enabled"
2100
2101
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002102dispatch <address>:<port>
2103 Set a default server address
2104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2105 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002106 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002107
2108 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2109 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2110 during start-up.
2111
2112 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2113 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2114 possible with normal servers.
2115
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002116 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002117 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2118 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2119 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2120 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2121
2122 See also : "server"
2123
2124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125enabled
2126 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 yes | yes | yes | yes
2129 Arguments : none
2130
2131 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2132 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2133
2134 See also : "disabled"
2135
2136
2137errorfile <code> <file>
2138 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments :
2142 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002143 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
2145 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002146 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002148 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2149 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150
2151 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2152 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2153 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2154
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002155 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2158 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2159 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2160 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2161
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002162 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2163 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2164 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2165 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2166 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2167 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2170 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2171 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002172 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2174
2175 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2176
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002177 Example :
2178 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2179 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2180 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2181
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002182
2183errorloc <code> <url>
2184errorloc302 <code> <url>
2185 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2187 yes | yes | yes | yes
2188 Arguments :
2189 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002190 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002191
2192 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2193 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2194 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2195 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2196 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2197
2198 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2199 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2200 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2201
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002202 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2203
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002204 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2205 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2206 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2207 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2208 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2209 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2210 request.
2211
2212 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2213
2214
2215errorloc303 <code> <url>
2216 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2218 yes | yes | yes | yes
2219 Arguments :
2220 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2221 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2222
2223 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2224 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2225 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2226 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2227 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2228
2229 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2230 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2231 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2232
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002233 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002235 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2236 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2237 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2238 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002239 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002240
2241 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2242
2243
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002244force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2245 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2247 no | yes | yes | yes
2248
2249 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2250 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2251 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2252 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2253 marked down for maintenance operations.
2254
2255 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2256 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2257 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2258 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2259 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2260 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2261 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2262 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2263 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2264
2265 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2266 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2267 is used.
2268
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002269 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002270 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002271
2272
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002273fullconn <conns>
2274 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2276 yes | no | yes | yes
2277 Arguments :
2278 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2279 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2280
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002281 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002282 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002283 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002284 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2285 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2286 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2287 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2288 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002289 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002290
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002291 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2292 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2293 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2294
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002295 Example :
2296 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2297 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2298 # connections.
2299 backend dynamic
2300 fullconn 10000
2301 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2302 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2303
2304 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2305
2306
2307grace <time>
2308 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002310 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002311 Arguments :
2312 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2313 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2314 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2315
2316 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2317 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002318 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002319 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2320
2321 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2322 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2323 simplify it.
2324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002325
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002326hash-type <method>
2327 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2329 yes | no | yes | yes
2330 Arguments :
2331 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2332 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2333 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2334 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2335 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2336 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2337 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2338 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2339 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2340
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002341 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2342 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2343 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2344 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2345 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2346 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2347 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2348 this value.
2349
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002350 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2351 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2352 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2353 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2354 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2355 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2356 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2357 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2358 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2359 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2360 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2361 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2362 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2363
2364 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2365
2366 See also : "balance", "server"
2367
2368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369http-check disable-on-404
2370 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002372 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373 Arguments : none
2374
2375 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2376 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2377 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2378 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2379 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2380 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2381 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2382 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002383 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2384 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2385 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2386
2387 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2388
2389
2390http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2391 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002394 Arguments :
2395 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2396 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002397 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002398 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2399 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2400 details on the supported keywords.
2401
2402 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2403 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2404 with the usual backslash ('\').
2405
2406 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2407 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2408 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2409 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2410 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2411
2412 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2413 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2414 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2415 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2416 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2417
2418 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2419 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2420 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2421 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2422 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2423 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2424
2425 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2426 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2427 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2428 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2429 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2430 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2431 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2432 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2433 trace).
2434
2435 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2436 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2437 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2438 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2439 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2440 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2441 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2442 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2443
2444 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2445 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2446 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2447 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2448 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2449 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2450 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2451 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2452
2453 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2454 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2455
2456 Examples :
2457 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002458 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002459
2460 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002461 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002462
2463 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002464 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002465
2466 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002467 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002469 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002470
2471
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002472http-check send-state
2473 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | no | yes | yes
2476 Arguments : none
2477
2478 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2479 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2480 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2481 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2482 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2483
2484 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2485 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2486 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2487 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2488 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2489 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2490 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2491 checked in multiple backends.
2492
2493 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2494 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2495
2496 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2497 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2498 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2499 one fails.
2500
2501 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2502 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2503 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2504
2505 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2506 server's queue.
2507
2508 Example of a header received by the application server :
2509 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2510 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2511
2512 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2513
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002514http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002515 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002516 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2517
2518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2519 no | yes | yes | yes
2520
2521 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2522 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2523 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002524 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2525 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002526 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2527
2528 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2529 instance.
2530
2531 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002532 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2533 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2534 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002535
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002536 http-request allow if nagios
2537 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2538 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2539 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002540
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002541 Example:
2542 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002543
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002544 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002545
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002546 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2547 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002548
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002549http-send-name-header [<header>]
2550 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2551
2552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2553 yes | no | yes | yes
2554
2555 Arguments :
2556
2557 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2558
2559 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2560 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2561 is added with the header string proved.
2562
2563 See also : "server"
2564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002565id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002566 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 no | yes | yes | yes
2569 Arguments : none
2570
2571 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2572 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2573 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002574
2575
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002576ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2577 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 no | yes | yes | yes
2580
2581 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2582 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2583 and running).
2584
2585 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2586 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2587 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2588 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2589 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2590
2591 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2592 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2593
2594 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2595 "unless" condition is met.
2596
2597 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2598
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002601log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002602no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002603 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002606
2607 Prefix :
2608 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2609 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2610 prefix does not allow arguments.
2611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002612 Arguments :
2613 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2614 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2615 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2616 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2617 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2618 parameter.
2619
2620 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2621 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2622
2623 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2624 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2625 standard syslog port).
2626
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002627 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2628 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2629 standard syslog port).
2630
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002631 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2632 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2633 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2634 appropriately writeable).
2635
2636 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2637
2638 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2639 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2640 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2641
2642 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2643 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2644 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002645 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2646 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2647 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2648 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2649 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002650
2651 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2652
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002653 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2654 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2655 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002656
2657 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2658 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2659 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2660 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2661
2662 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2663 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664
2665 Example :
2666 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002667 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2668 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002669
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002670log-format <string>
2671 Allows you to custom a log line.
2672
2673 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2674
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002675
2676maxconn <conns>
2677 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | yes | yes | no
2680 Arguments :
2681 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2682 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2683 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2684 closes.
2685
2686 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2687 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2688 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2689 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2690 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2691 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2692 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2693 properly tuned.
2694
2695 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2696 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2697 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2698
2699 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2700
2701
2702mode { tcp|http|health }
2703 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2705 yes | yes | yes | yes
2706 Arguments :
2707 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2708 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2709 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2710 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2711
2712 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2713 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2714 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2715 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2716 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2717
2718 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2719 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2720 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2721 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2722 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2723 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2724
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002725 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2726 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2727 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002729 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002730 defaults http_instances
2731 mode http
2732
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002733 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002736monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002737 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2739 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 Arguments :
2741 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2742 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002743 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2745 backend and its backup.
2746
2747 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2748 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2749 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2750 servers in a list of backends.
2751
2752 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2753 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2754 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2755 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2756 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2757 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2758 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002759 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2760 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
2762 Example:
2763 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002764 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2766 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2767 monitor-uri /site_alive
2768 monitor fail if site_dead
2769
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002770 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002771
2772
2773monitor-net <source>
2774 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2776 yes | yes | yes | no
2777 Arguments :
2778 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2779 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2780 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2781 followed by a mask.
2782
2783 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2784 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002785 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002786 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2787
2788 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2789 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2790 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2791 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2792 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2793
2794 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2795 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2796 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2797 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2798 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2799
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002800 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2801 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002803 Example :
2804 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2805 frontend www
2806 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2807
2808 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2809
2810
2811monitor-uri <uri>
2812 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 yes | yes | yes | no
2815 Arguments :
2816 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2817 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2818
2819 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2820 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2821 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2822 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2823 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2824 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2825 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2826 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2827
2828 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2829 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2830 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2831 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2832 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2833 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2834
2835 Example :
2836 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2837 frontend www
2838 mode http
2839 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2840
2841 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002844option abortonclose
2845no option abortonclose
2846 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2848 yes | no | yes | yes
2849 Arguments : none
2850
2851 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2852 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2853 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2854 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002855 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002856 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2857 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2858 encountered while delivering the response.
2859
2860 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2861 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2862 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2863 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2864 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2865 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002866 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002867 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002868 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002869 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2870 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2871 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2872
2873 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2874 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2875 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2876 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2877 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2878 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2879 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2880 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002881 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002882
2883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2885
2886 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2887
2888
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002889option accept-invalid-http-request
2890no option accept-invalid-http-request
2891 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2893 yes | yes | yes | no
2894 Arguments : none
2895
2896 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2897 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2898 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2899 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2900 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2901 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2902 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2903 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002904 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2905 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2906 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2907 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2908 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2909 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002910
2911 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2912 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2913 been confirmed.
2914
2915 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2916 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002917 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2918 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002919 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2920
2921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2923
2924 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2925 stats socket.
2926
2927
2928option accept-invalid-http-response
2929no option accept-invalid-http-response
2930 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2932 yes | no | yes | yes
2933 Arguments : none
2934
2935 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2936 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2937 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2938 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2939 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2940 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2941 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2942 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2943 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2944
2945 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2946 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2947 been confirmed.
2948
2949 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2950 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2951 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2952 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2953
2954 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2955 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2956
2957 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2958 stats socket.
2959
2960
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002961option allbackups
2962no option allbackups
2963 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2965 yes | no | yes | yes
2966 Arguments : none
2967
2968 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2969 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2970 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2971 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2972 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2973 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2974 order between the backup servers anymore.
2975
2976 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2977 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2978
2979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2981
2982
2983option checkcache
2984no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002985 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2987 yes | no | yes | yes
2988 Arguments : none
2989
2990 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2991 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002992 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002993 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2994 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002995 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002996
2997 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002998 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002999 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3001 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003002 to the client are :
3003 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003004 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003005 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003006 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3007 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3008 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3009 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3010 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3011 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3012 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3013 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3014 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3015 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3016 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3017
3018 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003019 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003021 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3023
3024 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3025 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003026 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003027 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3028
3029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3031
3032
3033option clitcpka
3034no option clitcpka
3035 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3037 yes | yes | yes | no
3038 Arguments : none
3039
3040 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3041 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3042 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3043 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3044
3045 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3046 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3047 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3048 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3049
3050 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3051 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3052 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3053 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3054 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3055
3056 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3057
3058 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3059 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3060 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3061
3062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3064
3065 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3066
3067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068option contstats
3069 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 yes | yes | yes | no
3072 Arguments : none
3073
3074 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3075 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3076 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3077 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3078 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3079 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3080 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3081
3082
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003083option dontlog-normal
3084no option dontlog-normal
3085 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | yes | yes | no
3088 Arguments : none
3089
3090 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3091 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3092 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3093 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3094 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3095 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3096 logged.
3097
3098 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3099 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3100 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003102 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003103 logging.
3104
3105
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003106option dontlognull
3107no option dontlognull
3108 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | yes | yes | no
3111 Arguments : none
3112
3113 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3114 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3115 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3116 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3117 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3118 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3119 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3120
3121 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3122 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3123 would not be logged.
3124
3125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003128 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003129
3130
3131option forceclose
3132no option forceclose
3133 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003135 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003136 Arguments : none
3137
3138 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3139 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3140 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3141 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3142 global session times in the logs.
3143
3144 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003145 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003146 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3147 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3148 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3149 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003150
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003151 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3152 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3153 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3154
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3157
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003158 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003159
3160
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003161option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003162 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 yes | yes | yes | yes
3165 Arguments :
3166 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3167 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003168 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003169 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003170
3171 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3172 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3173 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3174 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3175 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3176 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3177 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003178 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3179 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3180 possible that the client has already brought one.
3181
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003182 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003183 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003184 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3185 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003186 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3187 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003188
3189 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3190 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3191 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3192 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3193 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3194 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3195 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3196
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003197 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3198 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3199 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3200 are under the control of the end-user.
3201
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003202 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003203 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3204 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003205 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3206 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3207 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003208
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003209 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3210 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3211 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3212 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3213 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003214
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003215 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3217 frontend www
3218 mode http
3219 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3220
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003221 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3222 backend www
3223 mode http
3224 option forwardfor header X-Client
3225
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003226 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3227 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003228
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003229
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003230option http-no-delay
3231no option http-no-delay
3232 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3234 yes | yes | yes | yes
3235 Arguments : none
3236
3237 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3238 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3239 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3240 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3241 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3242 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3243 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3244 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3245 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3246 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3247 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3248 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3249 affected.
3250
3251 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3252 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3253 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3254 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3255 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3256 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3257 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3258 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3259 latency environments.
3260
3261
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003262option http-pretend-keepalive
3263no option http-pretend-keepalive
3264 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 yes | yes | yes | yes
3267 Arguments : none
3268
3269 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3270 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3271 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3272 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3273 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3274 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3275 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3276 consider the response complete.
3277
3278 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3279 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3280 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3281 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3282 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3283 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3284
3285 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3286 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3287 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3288 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3289 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3290 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3291 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3292
3293 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3294 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003295 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3296 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3297 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003298
3299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3301
3302 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3303
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003304
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003305option http-server-close
3306no option http-server-close
3307 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3309 yes | yes | yes | yes
3310 Arguments : none
3311
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003312 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3313 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3314 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3315 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3316 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3317 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3318 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3319 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3320 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3321 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3322 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3323 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003324
3325 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3326 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3327 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3328 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003329 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3330 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003331
3332 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3333 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003334 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3335 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3336 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003337
3338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3340
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003341 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3342 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003343
3344
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003345option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003346no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003347 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3349 yes | yes | yes | no
3350 Arguments : none
3351
3352 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3353 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3354 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3355 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3356 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3357 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3358 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3359
3360 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3361 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3362 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3363 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3364 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3365 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3366 request along its whole life.
3367
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003368 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3369 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3370 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3371 front of an existing proxy.
3372
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003373 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3374
3375 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3376 http-server-close".
3377
3378
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003379option httpchk
3380option httpchk <uri>
3381option httpchk <method> <uri>
3382option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3383 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | no | yes | yes
3386 Arguments :
3387 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3388 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3389 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3390 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3391 ones.
3392
3393 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3394 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3395 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3396
3397 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3398 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3399 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3400 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3401 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3402
3403 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3404 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3405 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3406 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3407 the lack of any response.
3408
3409 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3410
3411 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3412 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3413 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3414
3415 Examples :
3416 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3417 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3418 backend https_relay
3419 mode tcp
3420 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3421 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3422
3423 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003424 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3425 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003426
3427
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428option httpclose
3429no option httpclose
3430 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3432 yes | yes | yes | yes
3433 Arguments : none
3434
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003435 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3436 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3437 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3438 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3439 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3440 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3441 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442
3443 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003444 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3445 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3446 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3447 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3448 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3449 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003450
3451 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3452 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3453 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003454 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3455 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003456
3457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3459
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003460 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3461 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003462
3463
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003464option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003465 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003468 Arguments :
3469 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3470 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3471 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3472 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3473 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003474
3475 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3476 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3477 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3478 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3479 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3480 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3481 ports.
3482
3483 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3484
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3487 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3488 by default.
3489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003490 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003492
3493option http_proxy
3494no option http_proxy
3495 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3497 yes | yes | yes | yes
3498 Arguments : none
3499
3500 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3501 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3502 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3503 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3504 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3505
3506 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3507 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3508 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3509 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003510 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003511 be analyzed.
3512
3513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3515
3516 Example :
3517 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3518 backend direct_forward
3519 option httpclose
3520 option http_proxy
3521
3522 See also : "option httpclose"
3523
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003524
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003525option independant-streams
3526no option independant-streams
3527 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3529 yes | yes | yes | yes
3530 Arguments : none
3531
3532 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3533 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3534 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3535 receive data or not.
3536
3537 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3538 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3539 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3540 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3541 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3542 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3543 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3544 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3545 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3546 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3547 socket buffers.
3548
3549 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3550 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3551 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3552 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3553 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3554
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003555 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003556
3557
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003558option ldap-check
3559 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | no | yes | yes
3562 Arguments : none
3563
3564 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3565 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3566 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3567 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3568
3569 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3570 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3571
3572 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3573 configure it.
3574
3575 Example :
3576 option ldap-check
3577
3578 See also : "option httpchk"
3579
3580
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003581option log-health-checks
3582no option log-health-checks
3583 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | no | yes | yes
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3589 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3590 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3591 of additional information is limited.
3592
3593 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3594 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3595
3596 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3597
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003598
3599option log-separate-errors
3600no option log-separate-errors
3601 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | yes | yes | no
3604 Arguments : none
3605
3606 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3607 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3608 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3609 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3610 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3611 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3612 provides very important information.
3613
3614 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3615 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3616 error logs.
3617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003618 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003619 logging.
3620
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003621
3622option logasap
3623no option logasap
3624 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 yes | yes | yes | no
3627 Arguments : none
3628
3629 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3630 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3631 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3632 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3633 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3634 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3635 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003636 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3638 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003640 Examples :
3641 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3642 mode http
3643 option httplog
3644 option logasap
3645 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3646
3647 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3648 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3649 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3650 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003652 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003653 logging.
3654
3655
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003656option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3657 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3659 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003660 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003661 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3662 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003663
3664 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3665 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3666 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3667 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3668 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3669 in the MySQL table, like this :
3670
3671 USE mysql;
3672 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3673 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3674
3675 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3676 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3677 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3678 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3679 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3680 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3681 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3682 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3683 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3684
3685 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3686 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003687
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003688 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003689
3690 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3691 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3692 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3693 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3694 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3695 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3696
3697 See also: "option httpchk"
3698
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003699option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3700 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | no | yes | yes
3703 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003704 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3705 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003706
3707 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3708 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3709 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3710 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3711
3712 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003713
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003714option nolinger
3715no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003716 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003717 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003719 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003720
3721 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3722 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3723 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3724 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3725 connections.
3726
3727 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3728 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3729 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3730 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3731 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3732 this too.
3733
3734 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3735 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3736 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3737
3738 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3739 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3740 for servers.
3741
3742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3744
3745
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003746option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3747 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | yes
3750 Arguments :
3751 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3752 matching <network>
3753 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3754 header name.
3755
3756 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3757 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3758 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3759 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3760 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3761 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3762 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3763 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3764 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3765 possible that the client has already brought one.
3766
3767 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3768 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3769 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3770 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3771 header and requires different one.
3772
3773 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3774 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3775 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3776 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3777 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3778 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3779 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3780
3781 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3782 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3783 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3784 both are defined.
3785
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003786 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3787 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3788 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3789 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3790 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003791
3792 Examples :
3793 # Original Destination address
3794 frontend www
3795 mode http
3796 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3797
3798 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3799 backend www
3800 mode http
3801 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3802
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003803 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3804 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003805
3806
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003807option persist
3808no option persist
3809 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003812 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003813
3814 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3815 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3816 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3817 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3818 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3819 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3820 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3821 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3822 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3823 redirected to another valid server.
3824
3825 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3826 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3827
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003828 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003829
3830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003831option redispatch
3832no option redispatch
3833 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003836 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003837
3838 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3839 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3840 be able to access the service anymore.
3841
3842 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3843 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3844
3845 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3846 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3847 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003849 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3850 "redisp" keywords.
3851
3852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3854
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003855 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003856
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003857
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003858option redis-check
3859 Use redis health checks for server testing
3860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | no | yes | yes
3862 Arguments : none
3863
3864 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3865 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3866 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3867 find the "+PONG" response message.
3868
3869 Example :
3870 option redis-check
3871
3872 See also : "option httpchk"
3873
3874
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003875option smtpchk
3876option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3877 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003880 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003881 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3882 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3883 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3884
3885 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3886 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3887 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3888
3889 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3890 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3891 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3892 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3893 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3894 dead server.
3895
3896 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3897 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3898 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3899 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3900
3901 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3902 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3903 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3904 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3905 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3906
3907 Example :
3908 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3909
3910 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003913option socket-stats
3914no option socket-stats
3915
3916 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | yes | yes | no
3919
3920 Arguments : none
3921
3922
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003923option splice-auto
3924no option splice-auto
3925 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3927 yes | yes | yes | yes
3928 Arguments : none
3929
3930 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3931 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3932 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3933 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003934 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003935 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3936 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3937 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3938 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3939
3940 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3941 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3942 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3943 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3944 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3945 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3946 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3947 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3948 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3949 keyword.
3950
3951 Example :
3952 option splice-auto
3953
3954 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3955 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3956
3957 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3958 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3959
3960
3961option splice-request
3962no option splice-request
3963 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966 Arguments : none
3967
3968 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3969 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3970 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3971 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3972 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3973 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3974
3975 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3976
3977 Example :
3978 option splice-request
3979
3980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3982
3983 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3984 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3985
3986
3987option splice-response
3988no option splice-response
3989 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3991 yes | yes | yes | yes
3992 Arguments : none
3993
3994 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3995 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3996 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3997 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3998 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3999 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4000
4001 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4002
4003 Example :
4004 option splice-response
4005
4006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4008
4009 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4010 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4011
4012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004013option srvtcpka
4014no option srvtcpka
4015 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4017 yes | no | yes | yes
4018 Arguments : none
4019
4020 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4021 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4022 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4023 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4024
4025 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4026 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4027 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4028 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4029
4030 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4031 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4032 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4033 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4034 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4035
4036 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4037
4038 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4039 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4040 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4041
4042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4044
4045 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4046
4047
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004048option ssl-hello-chk
4049 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4051 yes | no | yes | yes
4052 Arguments : none
4053
4054 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4055 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4056 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4057 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4058 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4059 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4060 hello message.
4061
4062 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4063 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4064 messages, which is appreciable.
4065
4066 See also: "option httpchk"
4067
4068
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004069option tcp-smart-accept
4070no option tcp-smart-accept
4071 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4073 yes | yes | yes | no
4074 Arguments : none
4075
4076 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4077 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4078 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4079 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4080 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4081 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4082
4083 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4084 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4085 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4086 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4087
4088 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4089 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4090 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4091 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4092
4093 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4094 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4095 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4096
4097 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4098 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4099 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4100
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004101 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4102
4103
4104option tcp-smart-connect
4105no option tcp-smart-connect
4106 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | no | yes | yes
4109 Arguments : none
4110
4111 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4112 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4113 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4114 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4115 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4116
4117 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4118 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4119 complex.
4120
4121 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4122 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4123 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4124
4125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4127
4128 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4129
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004130
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004131option tcpka
4132 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | yes
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4138 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4139 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4140 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4141
4142 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4143 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4144 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4145 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4146
4147 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4148 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4149 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4150 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4151 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4152
4153 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4154
4155 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4156 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4157 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4158 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4159 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4160 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4161 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4162 backends.
4163
4164 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4165
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004166
4167option tcplog
4168 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | yes | yes | yes
4171 Arguments : none
4172
4173 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4174 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4175 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4176 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4177 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4178 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4179 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4180 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4181
4182 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004184 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004185
4186
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004187option transparent
4188no option transparent
4189 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004191 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004192 Arguments : none
4193
4194 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4195 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4196 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4197 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4198 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4199 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4200 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4201 appropriate server.
4202
4203 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4204 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4205
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004206 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004207 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004208
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004209
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004210persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004211persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004212 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4214 yes | no | yes | yes
4215 Arguments :
4216 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004217 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4218 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004219
4220 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4221 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4222 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4223 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4224 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4225 forwarded to this server.
4226
4227 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4228 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4229 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004230 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004231 a single "listen" section.
4232
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004233 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4234 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4235 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4236
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004237 Example :
4238 listen tse-farm
4239 bind :3389
4240 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4241 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4242 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4243 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4244 persist rdp-cookie
4245 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004246 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004247 balance rdp-cookie
4248 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4249 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4250
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004251 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4252 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004253
4254
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004255rate-limit sessions <rate>
4256 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4258 yes | yes | yes | no
4259 Arguments :
4260 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4261 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4262
4263 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4264 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4265 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4266 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4267 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4268 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4269
4270 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4271 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4272 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4273 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4274
4275 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4276 listen smtp
4277 mode tcp
4278 bind :25
4279 rate-limit sessions 10
4280 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4281
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004282 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4283 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4284 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004285
4286 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4287
4288
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004289redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4290redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004291 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4293 no | yes | yes | yes
4294
4295 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004296 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004297
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004298 Arguments :
4299 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4300 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4301 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4302 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004303 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4304 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4305 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4306 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004307
4308 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4309 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4310 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4311 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4312 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4313 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4314 location with a GET method.
4315
4316 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4317 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4318
4319 - "drop-query"
4320 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4321 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4322 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4323 with a location-type redirect.
4324
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004325 - "append-slash"
4326 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4327 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4328 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4329 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4330
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004331 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4332 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4333 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4334 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4335 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4336 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4337 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4338
4339 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4340 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4341 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4342 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4343 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4344 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4345 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004346
4347 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4348 acl clear dst_port 80
4349 acl secure dst_port 8080
4350 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004351 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004352 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004353 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4354
4355 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004356 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4357 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4358 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004359 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004360
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004361 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4362 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4363 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004365 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004366
4367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004368redisp (deprecated)
4369redispatch (deprecated)
4370 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4372 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004373 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004374
4375 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4376 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4377 be able to access the service anymore.
4378
4379 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4380 redistribute them to a working server.
4381
4382 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4383 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4384 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004386 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4387 "option redispatch" instead.
4388
4389 See also : "option redispatch"
4390
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004391
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004392reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 no | yes | yes | yes
4396 Arguments :
4397 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4398 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004399 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004400
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004401 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4402 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4403
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004404 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4405 the last header of an HTTP request.
4406
4407 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4408 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4409 responses.
4410
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004411 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4412 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4413 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4414
4415 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4416 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004417
4418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004419reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4420reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004421 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 no | yes | yes | yes
4424 Arguments :
4425 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4426 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4427 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4428 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4429 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4430 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4431 ignores case.
4432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004433 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4434 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004436 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4437 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4438 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4439 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004440 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441
4442 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4443 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4444
4445 Example :
4446 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4447 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4448 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4449
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004450 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4451 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004452
4453
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004454reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4455reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004456 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 no | yes | yes | yes
4459 Arguments :
4460 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4461 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4462 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4463 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4464 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4465 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4466
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004467 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4468 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4469
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004470 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4471 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4472 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4473 next servers.
4474
4475 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4476 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4477 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4478
4479 Example :
4480 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4481 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4482 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4483
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004484 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4485 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004486
4487
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004488reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4489reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004490 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 no | yes | yes | yes
4493 Arguments :
4494 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4495 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4496 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4497 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4498 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4499 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4500 case.
4501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004502 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4503 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004505 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4506 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4507 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4508 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004509 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004510
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004511 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004512 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004513 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004514
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004515 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4516 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4517
4518 Example :
4519 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4520 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4521 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4522
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004523 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4524 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004525
4526
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004527reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4528reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004529 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 no | yes | yes | yes
4532 Arguments :
4533 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4534 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4535 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4536 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4537 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4538 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4539 case.
4540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004541 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4542 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4543
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004544 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4545 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4546 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4547 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4548
4549 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4550 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4551
4552 Example :
4553 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4554 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4555 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4556 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4557
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004558 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4559 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004560
4561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004562reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4563reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004564 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4566 no | yes | yes | yes
4567 Arguments :
4568 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4569 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4570 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4571 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4572 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4573 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4574
4575 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4576 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4577 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4578 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004579 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004581 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4582 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4583
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004584 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4585 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4586 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4587
4588 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4589 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4590 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4591 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4592 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4593
4594 Example :
4595 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4596 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4597 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4598 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4599
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004600 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4601 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004602
4603
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004604reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4605reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004606 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 no | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
4610 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4611 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4612 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4613 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4614 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4615 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4616 ignores case.
4617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004618 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4619 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4620
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004621 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4622 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004623 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4624 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4625 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004626 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4627 not set.
4628
4629 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4630 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4631 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4632 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4633 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4634
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004635 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004636 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4637 # block all others.
4638 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4639 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4640
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004641 # block bad guys
4642 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4643 reqitarpit . if badguys
4644
4645 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4646 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004647
4648
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004649retries <value>
4650 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 yes | no | yes | yes
4653 Arguments :
4654 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4655 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4656 default value is 3.
4657
4658 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4659 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4660 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4661
4662 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4663 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4664
4665 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4666 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4667
4668 See also : "option redispatch"
4669
4670
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004671rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004672 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4674 no | yes | yes | yes
4675 Arguments :
4676 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4677 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004678 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4681 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4682
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4684 the last header of an HTTP response.
4685
4686 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4687 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4688 responses.
4689
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004690 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4691 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004692
4693
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004694rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4695rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004696 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 no | yes | yes | yes
4699 Arguments :
4700 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4701 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4702 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4703 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4704 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4705 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4706 ignores case.
4707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004708 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4709 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4710
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004711 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4712 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004713 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714 client.
4715
4716 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4717 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4718 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4719
4720 Example :
4721 # remove the Server header from responses
4722 reqidel ^Server:.*
4723
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004724 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4725 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004726
4727
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004728rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4729rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004730 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 no | yes | yes | yes
4733 Arguments :
4734 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4735 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4736 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4737 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4738 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4739 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4740 ignores case.
4741
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004742 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4743 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4744
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004745 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4746 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4747 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4748 case-sensitive.
4749
4750 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004751 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4752 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4753 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004754
4755 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4756 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4757
4758 Example :
4759 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4760 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4761
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004762 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4763 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004764
4765
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004766rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4767rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4770 no | yes | yes | yes
4771 Arguments :
4772 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4773 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4774 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4775 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4776 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4777 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4778 ignores case.
4779
4780 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4781 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4782 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4783 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004784 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004785
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004786 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4787 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4788
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004789 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4790 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4791 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4792
4793 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4794 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4795 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4796 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4797 are not case-sensitive.
4798
4799 Example :
4800 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4801 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4802
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004803 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4804 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004805
4806
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004807server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004808 Declare a server in a backend
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 no | no | yes | yes
4811 Arguments :
4812 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004813 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4814 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004815
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004816 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4817 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4818 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4819 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004820 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4821 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4822 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4823 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4824 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4825 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004826
4827 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4828 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4829 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4830 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4831 adding this value to the client's port.
4832
4833 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4834 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004835 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004836
4837 Examples :
4838 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4839 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4840
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004841 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4842 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004843
4844
4845source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004846source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004847source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004848 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments :
4852 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4853 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4854 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4855 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4856
4857 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4858 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004859 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4860 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4861 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004862
4863 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4864 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4865 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4866 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4867 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4868 <addr>.
4869
4870 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4871 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4872 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4873 port.
4874
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004875 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4876 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4877 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4878 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4879 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4880 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4881 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4882 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4883 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4884 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4885 HTTP header.
4886
4887 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4888 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4889 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4890 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4891 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4892 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4893 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4894 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4895 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4896 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4897
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004898 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4899 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4900 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4901 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4902 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4903 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4904
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004905 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4906 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4907 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4908 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4909
4910 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4911 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4912 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4913 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4914 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4915 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4916
4917 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4918 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4919 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4920 there are two methods :
4921
4922 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4923 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4924 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4925 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4926 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4927 of the client ranges may be used.
4928
4929 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4930 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4931 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4932 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4933 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4934 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4935 same session.
4936
4937 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4938 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4939 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4940 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4941 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4942 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4943
4944 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4945 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4946 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004947 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004948
4949 Examples :
4950 backend private
4951 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4952 source 192.168.1.200
4953
4954 backend transparent_ssl1
4955 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4956 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4957
4958 backend transparent_ssl2
4959 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4960 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4961 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4962
4963 backend transparent_ssl3
4964 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4965 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4966 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4967
4968 backend transparent_smtp
4969 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4970 # with Tproxy version 4.
4971 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4972
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004973 backend transparent_http
4974 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4975 # proxy.
4976 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004978 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004979 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004981
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004982srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4983 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4985 yes | no | yes | yes
4986 Arguments :
4987 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4988 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4989 as explained at the top of this document.
4990
4991 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4992 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4993 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4994 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4995 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4996 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4997 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4998
4999 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5000 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5001 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5002 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5003 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005004 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005005 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005006 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005007
5008 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5009 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5010 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5011 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5012 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5013 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5014
5015 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5016 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5017
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005018 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5019 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005020
5021
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005022stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5023 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 no | no | yes | yes
5026
5027 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5028 matched.
5029
5030 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5031 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5032
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005033 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5034 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5035 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5036
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005037 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5038 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5039 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5040 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005041
5042 Example :
5043 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5044 backend stats_localhost
5045 stats enable
5046 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5047
5048 Example :
5049 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5050 backend stats_auth
5051 stats enable
5052 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5053 stats admin if TRUE
5054
5055 Example :
5056 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5057 userlist stats-auth
5058 group admin users admin
5059 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5060 group readonly users haproxy
5061 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5062
5063 backend stats_auth
5064 stats enable
5065 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5066 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5067 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5068 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5069
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005070 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5071 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5072 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005073
5074
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005075stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5076 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | no | yes | yes
5079 Arguments :
5080 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5081
5082 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5083
5084 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5085 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5086 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5087 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5088 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5089 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5090
5091 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5092 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5093 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005094 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005095
5096 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5097 report using "stats scope".
5098
5099 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5100 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5101 unobvious parameters.
5102
5103 Example :
5104 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5105 backend public_www
5106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5107 stats enable
5108 stats hide-version
5109 stats scope .
5110 stats uri /admin?stats
5111 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5112 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5113 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5114
5115 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5116 backend private_monitoring
5117 stats enable
5118 stats uri /admin?stats
5119 stats refresh 5s
5120
5121 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5122
5123
5124stats enable
5125 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | no | yes | yes
5128 Arguments : none
5129
5130 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5131 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5132 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5133 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5134 - stats auth : no authentication
5135 - stats scope : no restriction
5136
5137 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5138 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5139 unobvious parameters.
5140
5141 Example :
5142 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5143 backend public_www
5144 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5145 stats enable
5146 stats hide-version
5147 stats scope .
5148 stats uri /admin?stats
5149 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5150 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5151 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5152
5153 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5154 backend private_monitoring
5155 stats enable
5156 stats uri /admin?stats
5157 stats refresh 5s
5158
5159 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5160
5161
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005162stats hide-version
5163 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005166 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005168 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5169 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5170 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5171 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5172 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5173 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5177 unobvious parameters.
5178
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005179 Example :
5180 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5181 backend public_www
5182 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005183 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005184 stats hide-version
5185 stats scope .
5186 stats uri /admin?stats
5187 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5188 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5189 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005190
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005191 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5192 backend private_monitoring
5193 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005194 stats uri /admin?stats
5195 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005196
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005197 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005198
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005199
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005200stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5201 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5202 Access control for statistics
5203
5204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5205 no | no | yes | yes
5206
5207 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5208 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5209 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5210 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5211 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5212 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5213
5214 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5215 instance.
5216
5217 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5218 about ACL usage.
5219
5220
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005221stats realm <realm>
5222 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 yes | no | yes | yes
5225 Arguments :
5226 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5227 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5228 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5229
5230 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5231 using a backslash ('\').
5232
5233 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5234 only related to authentication.
5235
5236 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5237 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5238 unobvious parameters.
5239
5240 Example :
5241 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5242 backend public_www
5243 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5244 stats enable
5245 stats hide-version
5246 stats scope .
5247 stats uri /admin?stats
5248 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5249 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5250 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5251
5252 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5253 backend private_monitoring
5254 stats enable
5255 stats uri /admin?stats
5256 stats refresh 5s
5257
5258 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5259
5260
5261stats refresh <delay>
5262 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5264 yes | no | yes | yes
5265 Arguments :
5266 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5267 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5268 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5269 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5270 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5271 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5272
5273 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5274 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5275 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5276 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5277
5278 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5279 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5280 unobvious parameters.
5281
5282 Example :
5283 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5284 backend public_www
5285 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5286 stats enable
5287 stats hide-version
5288 stats scope .
5289 stats uri /admin?stats
5290 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5291 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5292 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5293
5294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5295 backend private_monitoring
5296 stats enable
5297 stats uri /admin?stats
5298 stats refresh 5s
5299
5300 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5301
5302
5303stats scope { <name> | "." }
5304 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | no | yes | yes
5307 Arguments :
5308 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5309 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5310 section in which the statement appears.
5311
5312 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5313 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5314 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5315 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5316 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5317 exists.
5318
5319 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5320 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5321 unobvious parameters.
5322
5323 Example :
5324 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5325 backend public_www
5326 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5327 stats enable
5328 stats hide-version
5329 stats scope .
5330 stats uri /admin?stats
5331 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5332 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5333 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5334
5335 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5336 backend private_monitoring
5337 stats enable
5338 stats uri /admin?stats
5339 stats refresh 5s
5340
5341 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5342
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005343
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005344stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005345 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | no | yes | yes
5348
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005349 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005350 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5351
5352 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5353 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5354
5355 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5356 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5357 unobvious parameters.
5358
5359 Example :
5360 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5361 backend private_monitoring
5362 stats enable
5363 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5364 stats uri /admin?stats
5365 stats refresh 5s
5366
5367 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5368 global section.
5369
5370
5371stats show-legends
5372 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5373 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5374 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5375 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5376 - IP (socket, server)
5377 - cookie (backend, server)
5378
5379 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5380 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5381 unobvious parameters.
5382
5383 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5384
5385
5386stats show-node [ <name> ]
5387 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 yes | no | yes | yes
5390 Arguments:
5391 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5392 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5393
5394 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5395 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5396 provided for each customer.
5397
5398 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5399 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5400 unobvious parameters.
5401
5402 Example:
5403 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5404 backend private_monitoring
5405 stats enable
5406 stats show-node Europe-1
5407 stats uri /admin?stats
5408 stats refresh 5s
5409
5410 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5411 section.
5412
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005413
5414stats uri <prefix>
5415 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | no | yes | yes
5418 Arguments :
5419 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5420 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5421 query string.
5422
5423 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5424 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5425 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5426 possible to reach it in the application.
5427
5428 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005429 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005430 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5431 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5432 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5433 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5434
5435 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5436 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5437 an address or a port to statistics only.
5438
5439 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5440 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5441 unobvious parameters.
5442
5443 Example :
5444 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5445 backend public_www
5446 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5447 stats enable
5448 stats hide-version
5449 stats scope .
5450 stats uri /admin?stats
5451 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5452 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5453 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5454
5455 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5456 backend private_monitoring
5457 stats enable
5458 stats uri /admin?stats
5459 stats refresh 5s
5460
5461 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5462
5463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005464stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5465 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005467 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005468
5469 Arguments :
5470 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5471 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5472 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5473 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5474
5475 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5476 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5477 the "stick-table" statement.
5478
5479 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5480 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5481 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5482 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5483 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5484
5485 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5486 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5487 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5488 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5489 transformation rules.
5490
5491 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5492 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5493 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5494 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5495 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5496 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5497 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5498
5499 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5500 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5501 ACL based conditions.
5502
5503 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5504 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5505 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5506 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5507
5508 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5509 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5510 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5511 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5512
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005513 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5514 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5515 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5516
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005517 Example :
5518 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5519 # last 30 minutes
5520 backend pop
5521 mode tcp
5522 balance roundrobin
5523 stick store-request src
5524 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5525 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5526 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5527
5528 backend smtp
5529 mode tcp
5530 balance roundrobin
5531 stick match src table pop
5532 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5533 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5534
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005535 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5536 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005537
5538
5539stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5540 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 no | no | yes | yes
5543
5544 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5545 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5546 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5547 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5548
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005549 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5550 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5551 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5552
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005553 Examples :
5554 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005555 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005556
5557 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5558 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5559 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5560
5561
5562 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5563 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5564 backend http
5565 mode http
5566 balance roundrobin
5567 stick on src table https
5568 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5569 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5570 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5571
5572 backend https
5573 mode tcp
5574 balance roundrobin
5575 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5576 stick on src
5577 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5578 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5579
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005580 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005581
5582
5583stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5584 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 no | no | yes | yes
5587
5588 Arguments :
5589 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5590 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5591 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5592 server is selected.
5593
5594 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5595 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5596 the "stick-table" statement.
5597
5598 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5599 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5600 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5601 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5602 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5603 address.
5604
5605 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5606 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5607 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5608 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5609 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5610 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5611 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5612 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5613 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5614 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5615
5616 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5617 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5618 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5619 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5620 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5621 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5622 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5623
5624 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5625 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5626 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5627 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5628
5629 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5630 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5631 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5632 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5633 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5634 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5635 another protocol or access method.
5636
5637 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5638 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5639 the request.
5640
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005641 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5642 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5643 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5644
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005645 Example :
5646 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5647 # last 30 minutes
5648 backend pop
5649 mode tcp
5650 balance roundrobin
5651 stick store-request src
5652 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5653 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5654 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5655
5656 backend smtp
5657 mode tcp
5658 balance roundrobin
5659 stick match src table pop
5660 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5661 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5662
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005663 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5664 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005665
5666
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005667stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005668 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5669 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005670 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005672 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005673
5674 Arguments :
5675 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5676 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5677 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5678 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5679
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005680 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5681 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5682 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5683 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5684
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005685 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5686 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5687 instance.
5688
5689 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5690 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5691 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5692 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5693 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5694 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005695 to 32 characters.
5696
5697 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5698 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5699 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5700 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5701 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5702 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005703
5704 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005705 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5706 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005707 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5708 increase.
5709
5710 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005711 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5712 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5713 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005714
5715 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5716 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5717 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5718 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5719 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5720 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5721 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5722 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5723 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5724 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5725 parameter (see below).
5726
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005727 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5728 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5729 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5730 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5731 soft restart.
5732
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005733 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5734
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005735 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5736 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5737 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5738 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5739 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005740 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005741 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5742 if not expiration delay is specified.
5743
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005744 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5745 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5746 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5747 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005748 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5749 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5750 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5751 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5752 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5753 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5754 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5755 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5756 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5757 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5758 types and their arguments.
5759
5760 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5761 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5762 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5763 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5764
5765 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5766 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5767 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5768 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5769
5770 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5771 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5772 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5773 they were received.
5774
5775 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5776 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5777 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5778 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5779 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5780
5781 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5782 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5783 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5784 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5785 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5786
5787 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5788 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5789 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5790
5791 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5792 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5793 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5794 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5795 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5796
5797 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5798 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5799 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5800 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5801 the client side.
5802
5803 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5804 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5805 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5806 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5807 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5808 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5809 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5810
5811 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5812 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5813 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5814 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5815 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5816 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5817 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5818
5819 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5820 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5821 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5822 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5823 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5824 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5825
5826 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5827 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5828 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5829 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5830
5831 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5832 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5833 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5834 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5835 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5836 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5837 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5838 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5839 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5840 recommended for better fairness.
5841
5842 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5843 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5844 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5845 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5846
5847 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5848 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5849 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5850 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5851 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5852 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5853 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5854 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5855 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5856 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005857
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005858 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5859 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005860 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5861 reference it.
5862
5863 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5864 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5865 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5866 as an exclusive stickiness.
5867
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005868 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5869 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5870 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5871 something that can be ignored.
5872
5873 Example:
5874 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5875 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5876 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5877 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5878
5879 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005880 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005881
5882
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005883stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5884 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 no | no | yes | yes
5887
5888 Arguments :
5889 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5890 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5891 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5892 server is selected.
5893
5894 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5895 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5896 the "stick-table" statement.
5897
5898 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5899 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5900 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5901 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5902
5903 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5904 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5905 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5906 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5907 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5908 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005909 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005910 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5911 rules.
5912
5913 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5914 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5915 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5916 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5917 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5918 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5919 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5920
5921 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5922 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5923 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5924 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5925
5926 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5927 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5928 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5929 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5930 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5931 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5932 another protocol or access method.
5933
5934 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5935
5936 Example :
5937 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5938 backend https
5939 mode tcp
5940 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005941 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005942 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005943
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005944 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5945 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5946
5947 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5948 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5949 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5950
5951 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5952 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005953
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005954 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5955 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5956 # at offset 44.
5957
5958 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5959 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5960
5961 # Learn on response if server hello.
5962 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005963
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005964 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5965 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5966
5967 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5968 extraction.
5969
5970
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005971tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5972 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005975 Arguments :
5976 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5977 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5978 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005981
5982 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5983 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005984 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5985 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5986 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5987 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5988 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5989 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5992 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5993 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5994 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005996 Three types of actions are supported :
5997 - accept :
5998 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5999 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6000 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006002 - reject :
6003 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6004 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6005 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6006 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6007 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6008 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6009 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6010 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6011 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6012 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6013 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6014 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006016 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6017 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6018 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6019 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6020 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6021 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6022 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6023 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6024 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006026 These actions take one or two arguments :
6027 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6028 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6029 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006031 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6032 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6033 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6034 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6037 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6038 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6039 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6040 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6041 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6042 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6043 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6044 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6045 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006047 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6048 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6049 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006051 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6052 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6053 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006055 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006056 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006057 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006059 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6060 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6061 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006063 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6064 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6065 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006066
6067 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006069 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006070
6071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6073 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006075 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006076 Arguments :
6077 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6078 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6079 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006081 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6084 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6085 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6086 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6087 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006089 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6090 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6091 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6092 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6093 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6094 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6095 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6096 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6097 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006099 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6100 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6101 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6102 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104 Three types of actions are supported :
6105 - accept :
6106 - reject :
6107 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6110 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6113 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6114 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6115 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6116 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6117 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006119 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6121 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006124 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6125 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6126 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6127 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6128 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006129
6130 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006131 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6132 # and reject everything else.
6133 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6134 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006135 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006136 tcp-request content reject
6137
6138 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006139 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6140 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6141 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006142 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006143
6144 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6145 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6146 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006147 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006148 tcp-request content reject
6149
6150 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6151 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6152
6153 frontend http
6154 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6155 # protecting all our sites
6156 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6157 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6158 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6159 ...
6160 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6161
6162 backend http_dynamic
6163 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6164 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6165 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6166 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6167 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6168 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6169 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006171 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006173 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006174
6175
6176tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6177 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006179 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006180 Arguments :
6181 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6182 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6183 as explained at the top of this document.
6184
6185 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6186 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6187 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6188 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6189 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6190
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006191 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6192 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6193 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6194 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6195
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006196 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6197 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006198 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006199 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006200 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6201 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6202 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6203 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006204
6205 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6206 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6207 it pass through unaffected.
6208
6209 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6210 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6211 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006212 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006213 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6214 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006215 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6216 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6217 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006218
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006219 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006220 "timeout client".
6221
6222
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006223tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6224 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 no | no | yes | yes
6227 Arguments :
6228 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6229 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6230 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6231
6232 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6233
6234 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6235 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6236 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6237 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006238 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006239
6240 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6241
6242 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6243 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6244 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6245 inserted.
6246
6247 Two types of actions are supported :
6248 - accept :
6249 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6250 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6251 the rules evaluation.
6252
6253 - reject :
6254 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6255 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6256 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6257
6258 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6259 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6260 for changing the default action to a reject.
6261
6262 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6263 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6264 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6265 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6266 period.
6267
6268 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6269
6270 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6271
6272
6273tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6274 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6276 no | no | yes | yes
6277 Arguments :
6278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6280 as explained at the top of this document.
6281
6282 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6283
6284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006285timeout check <timeout>
6286 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6287 established.
6288
6289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | no | yes | yes
6291 Arguments:
6292 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6293 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6294 as explained at the top of this document.
6295
6296 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6297 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6298 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6299 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006300 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6301 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6302 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006303
6304 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6305 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6306
6307 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6308 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006309 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006310
6311 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6312 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6313 forget about it.
6314
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006315 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6316 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006317
6318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006319timeout client <timeout>
6320timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6321 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6323 yes | yes | yes | no
6324 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006325 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006326 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6327 as explained at the top of this document.
6328
6329 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6330 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6331 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6332 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6333 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6334 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6335 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6336 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006337 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006338 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006339 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6340 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6341 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006342
6343 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6344 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6345 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6346 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6347 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6348 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6349
6350 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6351 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6352 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6353
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006354 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006355
6356
6357timeout connect <timeout>
6358timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6359 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | no | yes | yes
6362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006363 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006364 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6365 as explained at the top of this document.
6366
6367 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006368 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006369 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006370 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006371 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6372 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373
6374 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6375 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6376 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6377 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6378 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6379 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6380
6381 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6382 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6383 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6384
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006385 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6386 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006387
6388
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006389timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6390 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 yes | yes | yes | yes
6393 Arguments :
6394 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6395 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6396 as explained at the top of this document.
6397
6398 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6399 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6400 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6401 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6402 once the request has started to present itself.
6403
6404 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6405 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6406 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6407 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6408 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6409
6410 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6411 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6412 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6413 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6414
6415 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6416 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6417 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6418 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6419 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006420 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006421
6422 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6423 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6424 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6425 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6426
6427 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6428
6429
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006430timeout http-request <timeout>
6431 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006433 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006434 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6437 as explained at the top of this document.
6438
6439 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6440 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6441 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6442 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6443 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6444 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6445 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6446 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6447
6448 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6449 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006450 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6451 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006452
6453 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6454 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6455 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6456 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6457 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6458
6459 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006460 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6461 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6462 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006463
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006464 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006465
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006466
6467timeout queue <timeout>
6468 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6470 yes | no | yes | yes
6471 Arguments :
6472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6474 as explained at the top of this document.
6475
6476 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6477 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6478 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6479 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6480 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6481
6482 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6483 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6484 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6485 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6486
6487 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6488
6489
6490timeout server <timeout>
6491timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6492 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 yes | no | yes | yes
6495 Arguments :
6496 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6497 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6498 as explained at the top of this document.
6499
6500 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6501 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6502 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6503 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6504 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6505 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6506 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6507
6508 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6509 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6510 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6511 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6512 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006513 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006514 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006515 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6516 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6517 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6518 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006519
6520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6521 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6522 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6523 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6524 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6525 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6526
6527 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6528 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6529 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6530
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006531 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006532
6533
6534timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006535 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
6538 Arguments :
6539 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6541 as explained at the top of this document.
6542
6543 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6544 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6545 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6546
6547 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6548 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6549 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6550 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006551 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006552
6553 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6554
6555
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006556timeout tunnel <timeout>
6557 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | no | yes | yes
6560 Arguments :
6561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6563 as explained at the top of this document.
6564
6565 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectionnal connection is established
6566 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6567 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6568 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6569 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6570 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6571 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6572 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6573 specified.
6574
6575 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6576 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6577 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6578 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6579 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6580
6581 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6582 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6583 forget about it.
6584
6585 Example :
6586 defaults http
6587 option http-server-close
6588 timeout connect 5s
6589 timeout client 30s
6590 timeout client 30s
6591 timeout server 30s
6592 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6593
6594 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6595
6596
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006597transparent (deprecated)
6598 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006600 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006601 Arguments : none
6602
6603 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6604 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6605 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6606 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6607 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6608 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6609 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6610 appropriate server.
6611
6612 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6613
6614 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6615 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6616
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006617 See also: "option transparent"
6618
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006619unique-id-format <string>
6620 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6622 yes | yes | yes | no
6623 Arguments :
6624 <string> is a log-format string.
6625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006626 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6627 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6628 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6629 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006630
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006631 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6632 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6633 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6634 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6635 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6636 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6637 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6638 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006640 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6641 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006643 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006644
6645 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6646
6647 will generate:
6648
6649 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6650
6651 See also: "unique-id-header"
6652
6653unique-id-header <name>
6654 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6656 yes | yes | yes | no
6657 Arguments :
6658 <name> is the name of the header.
6659
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006660 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6661 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006663 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006664
6665 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6666 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6667
6668 will generate:
6669
6670 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6671
6672 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006673
6674use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6675use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006676 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6678 no | yes | yes | no
6679 Arguments :
6680 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006682 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006683
6684 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6685 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6686 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006687 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6688 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6689 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6690 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006691
6692 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6693 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6694 assign the backend.
6695
6696 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6697 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6698 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6699 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6700 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6701 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6702
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006703 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006704 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006705 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6706 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6707 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6708
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006709 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006710
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006711
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006712use-server <server> if <condition>
6713use-server <server> unless <condition>
6714 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 no | no | yes | yes
6717 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006718 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006719
6720 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6721
6722 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6723 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6724 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6725
6726 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6727 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6728 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6729 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6730 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6731 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6732 matches will assign the server.
6733
6734 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6735 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6736 with the next rules until one matches.
6737
6738 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6739 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6740 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6741 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6742
6743 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6744 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6745 stripped.
6746
6747 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6748 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6749 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6750 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6751
6752 Example :
6753 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6754 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6755 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6756 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6757 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6758 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6759 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6760 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6761 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6762
6763 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6764
6765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067665. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006767------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006769The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6770which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6771arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6772settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6773after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6774Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6775address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006777 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006778 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006780The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006781
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006782addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006783 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6784 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6785 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6786 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6787 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006789 Supported in default-server: No
6790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791backup
6792 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6793 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6794 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6795 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6796 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6797 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006799 Supported in default-server: No
6800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006801check
6802 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006803 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6804 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6805 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6806 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6807 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6808 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6809 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6810 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6811 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6812 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006814 Supported in default-server: No
6815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006816cookie <value>
6817 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6818 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6819 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6820 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6821 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6822 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6823 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006825 Supported in default-server: No
6826
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006827disabled
6828 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6829 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6830 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6831 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6832 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6833
6834 Supported in default-server: No
6835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006836error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006837 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6838 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6839 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006841 Supported in default-server: Yes
6842
6843 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006845fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006846 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6847 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6848 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006850 Supported in default-server: Yes
6851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006852id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006853 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6854 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6855 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006857 Supported in default-server: No
6858
6859inter <delay>
6860fastinter <delay>
6861downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006862 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6863 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6864 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6865 between checks depending on the server state :
6866
6867 Server state | Interval used
6868 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6869 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6870 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6871 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6872 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6873 or yet unchecked. |
6874 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6875 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6876 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006878 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6879 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6880 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6881 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6882 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6883 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6884 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6885 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6886 servers.
6887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006888 Supported in default-server: Yes
6889
6890maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006891 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6892 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6893 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6894 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6895 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6896 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6897 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6898 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006900 Supported in default-server: Yes
6901
6902maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6904 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6905 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6906 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6907 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6908 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6909 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006911 Supported in default-server: Yes
6912
6913minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006914 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6915 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6916 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6917 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6918 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6919 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006920 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006921 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006923 Supported in default-server: Yes
6924
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006925non-stick
6926 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6927 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6928 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006930observe <mode>
6931 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6932 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6933 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6934 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6935 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6936 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006937 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006939 Supported in default-server: No
6940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006941 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006943on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006944 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6945 Currently, four modes are available:
6946 - fastinter: force fastinter
6947 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6948 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6949 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6950 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006952 Supported in default-server: Yes
6953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006954 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6955
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006956on-marked-down <action>
6957 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6958 Currently one action is available:
6959 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6960
6961 Actions are disabled by default
6962
6963 Supported in default-server: Yes
6964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006965port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006966 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6967 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6968 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6969 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6970 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6971 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006973 Supported in default-server: Yes
6974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006975redir <prefix>
6976 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6977 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6978 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6979 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6980 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6981 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6982 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6983 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006984 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006985 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6986 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6987 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6988 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6989 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6990
6991 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006993 Supported in default-server: No
6994
6995rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6997 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6998 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007000 Supported in default-server: Yes
7001
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007002send-proxy
7003 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7004 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7005 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7006 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7007 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7008 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7009 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7010 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7011 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7012 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7013 option of the "bind" keyword.
7014
7015 Supported in default-server: No
7016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007017slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007018 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7019 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7020 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7021 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7022 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7023 parameters :
7024
7025 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7026 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7027
7028 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7029 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7030 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7031 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7032
7033 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7034 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7035 seen as failed.
7036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007037 Supported in default-server: Yes
7038
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007039source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007040source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007041source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007042 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7043 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7044 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7045 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7046
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007047 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7048 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7049 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7050 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7051 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7052 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7053 server.
7054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007055 Supported in default-server: No
7056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007057track [<proxy>/]<server>
7058 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7059 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7060 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7061 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7062 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007064 Supported in default-server: No
7065
7066weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007067 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7068 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7069 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007070 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7071 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7072 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7073 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7074 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7075 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007077 Supported in default-server: Yes
7078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007079
70806. HTTP header manipulation
7081---------------------------
7082
7083In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7084response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7085request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7086which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7087against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7088to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7089passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7090headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7091never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7092
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007093There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7094(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7095rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7096messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7097in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007098happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007099add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7100normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007102This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7103in section 4.2 :
7104
7105 - reqadd <string>
7106 - reqallow <search>
7107 - reqiallow <search>
7108 - reqdel <search>
7109 - reqidel <search>
7110 - reqdeny <search>
7111 - reqideny <search>
7112 - reqpass <search>
7113 - reqipass <search>
7114 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7115 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7116 - reqtarpit <search>
7117 - reqitarpit <search>
7118 - rspadd <string>
7119 - rspdel <search>
7120 - rspidel <search>
7121 - rspdeny <search>
7122 - rspideny <search>
7123 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7124 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7125
7126With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7127is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7128parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7129prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7130Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7131
7132 \t for a tab
7133 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7134 \n for a new line (LF)
7135 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7136 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7137 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7138 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7139 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7140
7141The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7142portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7143above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7144regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
71459 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7146is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7147
7148The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7149after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7150
7151Notes related to these keywords :
7152---------------------------------
7153 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7154 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7155 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7156
7157 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7158 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7159 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7160
7161 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7162 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7163 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7164 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7165 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7166
7167 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7168 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7169 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7170 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7171 useless headers before adding new ones.
7172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007173 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007174 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7175
7176 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7177 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7178 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7179
7180 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7181 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007182 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007183
7184
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010071857. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7186------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007187
7188The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7189content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7190from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7191simple :
7192
7193 - define test criteria with sets of values
7194 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7195
7196The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7197
7198In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7199
7200 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7201
7202This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7203Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7204and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7205an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7206of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7207
7208ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7209'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7210which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7211
7212There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7213performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7214
7215The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7216
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007217 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7218 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007219 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7220
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007221The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7222specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7223possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007224multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7225be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7226needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7227space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7228match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7229lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7230duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7231to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7232instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007233
7234 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7235
7236In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7237the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7238case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7239too.
7240
7241Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7242a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7243ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007245Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007246
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007247 - integers or integer ranges
7248 - strings
7249 - regular expressions
7250 - IP addresses and networks
7251
7252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072537.1. Matching integers
7254----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007255
7256Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7257that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7258expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7259may be omitted.
7260
7261For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7262unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7263representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7264
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007265As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7266two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7267instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7268ranges and operators.
7269
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007270For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007271operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7272Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7273of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007275Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007276
7277 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7278 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7279 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7280 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7281 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007283For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007284
7285 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7286
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007287This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7288
7289 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072927.2. Matching strings
7293---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007294
7295String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7296exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7297characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7298string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7299to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007300before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007301
7302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073037.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7304-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007305
7306Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7307they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7308possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7309passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7310the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007311the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7312match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007313
7314
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073157.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007316----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007317
7318IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7319netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7320within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007321host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007322difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7323at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7324does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7325parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007326
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007327IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7328Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7329trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7330IPv6 patterns.
7331
7332HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7333following situations :
7334 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7335 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7336 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7337 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7338 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7339 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7340 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7341 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7342 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7343 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073467.5. Available matching criteria
7347--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073497.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7350------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007351
7352A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7353analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7354addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007356always_false
7357 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7358 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7359
7360always_true
7361 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7362 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7363
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007364avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007365avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007366 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7367 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7368 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7369 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7370 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7371 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7372 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7373 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7374 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7375 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7376 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007377
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007378be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007379be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007380 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7381 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7382 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7383 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7384 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007385
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007386be_id <integer>
7387 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7388 backend it was called.
7389
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007390be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007391be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007392 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7393 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7394 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7395 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7396 sucking of an online dictionary).
7397
7398 Example :
7399 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7400 backend dynamic
7401 mode http
7402 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7403 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007405connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007406connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007407 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007408 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007409 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7410
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007411 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7412 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007413
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007414 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007415 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7416 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7417 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7418 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7419 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007420 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007421
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007422 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7423 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7424 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7425 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007426
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007427dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007428 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7429 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007431dst_conn <integer>
7432 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7433 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7434 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7435 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7436 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7437 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7438
7439dst_port <integer>
7440 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7441 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7442
7443fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007444fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007445 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7446 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7447 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7448 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7449 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7450 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7451 criteria.
7452
7453fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007454 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007455 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007456
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007457fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007458fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007459 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7460 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7461 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7462 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7463 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7464 the rate to go down below the limit.
7465
7466 Example :
7467 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7468 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7469 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7470 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7471 frontend mail
7472 bind :25
7473 mode tcp
7474 maxconn 100
7475 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7476 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7477 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7478 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007480nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007481nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007482 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7483 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7484 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7485 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7486 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007487
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007488queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007489queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007490 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7491 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7492 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7493 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7494 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7495 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7496 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7497
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007498sc1_bytes_in_rate
7499sc2_bytes_in_rate
7500 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7501 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7502 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7503
7504sc1_bytes_out_rate
7505sc2_bytes_out_rate
7506 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7507 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7508 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7509
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007510sc1_clr_gpc0
7511sc2_clr_gpc0
7512 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7513 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7514 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7515 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7516 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7517 was verified :
7518
7519 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7520 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7521 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7522 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7523 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7524 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7525 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7526
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007527sc1_conn_cnt
7528sc2_conn_cnt
7529 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7530 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7531
7532sc1_conn_cur
7533sc2_conn_cur
7534 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7535 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7536 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7537
7538sc1_conn_rate
7539sc2_conn_rate
7540 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7541 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7542 See also src_conn_rate.
7543
7544sc1_get_gpc0
7545sc2_get_gpc0
7546 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7547 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7548
7549sc1_http_err_cnt
7550sc2_http_err_cnt
7551 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7552 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7553 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7554
7555sc1_http_err_rate
7556sc2_http_err_rate
7557 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7558 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7559 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7560 src_http_err_rate.
7561
7562sc1_http_req_cnt
7563sc2_http_req_cnt
7564 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7565 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7566 src_http_req_cnt.
7567
7568sc1_http_req_rate
7569sc2_http_req_rate
7570 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7571 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7572 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7573 src_http_req_rate.
7574
7575sc1_inc_gpc0
7576sc2_inc_gpc0
7577 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7578 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7579 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7580 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7581 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7582 when a first ACL was verified :
7583
7584 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7585 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7586 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7587
7588sc1_kbytes_in
7589sc2_kbytes_in
7590 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7591 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7592 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7593 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7594
7595sc1_kbytes_out
7596sc2_kbytes_out
7597 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7598 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7599 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7600 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7601
7602sc1_sess_cnt
7603sc2_sess_cnt
7604 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7605 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7606 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7607 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7608 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7609 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7610
7611sc1_sess_rate
7612sc2_sess_rate
7613 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7614 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7615 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7616 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7617 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7618 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007620so_id <integer>
7621 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7622
7623src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007624 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7625 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7626 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007627
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007628src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007629src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007630 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7631 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7632 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007633 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007634
7635src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007636src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007637 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7638 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7639 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007640 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007641
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007642src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7643src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7644 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7645 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7646 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7647 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7648 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7649 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7650
7651 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7652 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7653 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7654 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7655 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7656 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7658
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007659src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007660src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007661 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7662 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7663 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007664 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007665
7666src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007667src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007668 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7669 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7670 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007671 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007672
7673src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007674src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007675 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7676 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7677 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007678 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007679
7680src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007681src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007682 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7683 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7684 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007685 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007686
7687src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007688src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007689 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7690 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7691 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007692 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007693
7694src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007695src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007696 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7697 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7698 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7699 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007700 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007701
7702src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007703src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007704 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7705 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7706 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007707 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007708
7709src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007710src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007711 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7712 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7713 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7714 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007715 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007716
7717src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007718src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007719 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7720 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7721 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7722 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7723 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7724 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7725
7726 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7727 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007728 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007729
7730src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007731src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007732 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7733 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7734 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7735 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007736 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007737
7738src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007739src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007740 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7741 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7742 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7743 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007744 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007745
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007746src_port <integer>
7747 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007748
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007749src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007750src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007751 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7752 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7753 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7754 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007755 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007756
7757src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007758src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007759 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7760 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7761 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7762 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007763 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007764
7765src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007766src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007767 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007768 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7769 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007770 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7771 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7772 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007773 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007774
7775 Example :
7776 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7777 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7778 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7779 listen ssh
7780 bind :22
7781 mode tcp
7782 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007783 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007784 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7785 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7786
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007787srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007788 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7789 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7790 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7791 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7792
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007793srv_id <integer>
7794 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7795
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007796srv_is_up(<server>)
7797srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7798 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7799 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7800 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7801 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7802 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7803 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7804 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7805 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7806
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007807table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007808table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007809 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7810 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7811
7812table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007813table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007814 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7815 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7816 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078197.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7820---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007821
7822A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7823during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007824through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7825keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007826
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007827rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7828 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7829 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7830 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7831 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7832
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007833req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007834 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007835 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7836 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7837 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7838 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7839 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7840 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7841
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007842req_proto_http
7843 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7844 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007845 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007846 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7847 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7848
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007849req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007850req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007851 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7852 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7853 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7854 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7855 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7856 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7857 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7858 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7859
7860req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007861req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007862 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7863 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7864 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7865 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7866 cookies.
7867
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007868req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7869 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7870 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7871 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7872 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7873
7874req_ssl_sni <string>
7875 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7876 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7877 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7878 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7879 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7880 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7881 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7882 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7883
7884 Examples :
7885 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7886 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7887 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7888 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7889 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7890
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007891req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7892 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7893 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7894 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7895 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7896 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7897 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7898 with TCP request content inspection.
7899
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007900wait_end
7901 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7902 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7903 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7904 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7905 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7906 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7907 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7908 inspection.
7909
7910 Examples :
7911 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7912 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7913 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7914
7915 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7916 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7917 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7918 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7919 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7920 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7921 tcp-request content reject
7922
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079247.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7925--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007926
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007927A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007928application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7929read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7930than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7931
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007932cook(<name>) <string>
7933 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
7934 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
7935 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
7936 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
7937 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
7938 sent by the server.
7939
7940 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
7941 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
7942 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
7943
7944 cook(profile) silver gold
7945
7946cook_beg(<name>) <string>
7947 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
7948 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7949 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7950
7951cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
7952 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
7953 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
7954 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
7955 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
7956 server.
7957
7958cook_dir(<name>) <string>
7959 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7960 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7961 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
7962 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
7963 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7964
7965cook_dom(<name>) <string>
7966 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7967 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
7968 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7969 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7970
7971cook_end(<name>) <string>
7972 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
7973 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7974 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7975
7976cook_len(<name>) <integer>
7977 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
7978 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7979 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
7980 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
7981 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7982
7983cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
7984 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
7985 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
7986 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
7987 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7988 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7989
7990cook_sub(<name>) <string>
7991 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
7992 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7993 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7994
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02007995cook_val(<name>) <integer>
7996 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
7997 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
7998 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
7999 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8000 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008002hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008003hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8005 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8006 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8007 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008008 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8009 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8010 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8011 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8012 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008013
8014 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008015 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008016 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8017
8018 hdr(Connection) -i close
8019
8020hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008021hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008022 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8023 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8024 response headers sent by the server.
8025
8026hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008027hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008028 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8029 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8030 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8031 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8032 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8033 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8034 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8035
8036hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008037hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008038 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8039 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8040 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8041 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8042 headers sent by the server.
8043
8044hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008045hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008046 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8047 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8048 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8049 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8050 server.
8051
8052hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008053hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008054 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8055 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8056 response headers sent by the server.
8057
8058hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008059hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8060 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8061 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8062 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008063 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8064
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008065hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008066hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008067 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8068 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8069 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8070 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8071
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008073hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008074 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008075 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8076 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8077 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8078 response headers sent by the server.
8079
8080hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008081hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008082 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8083 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8084 response headers sent by the server.
8085
8086hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008087hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008088 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8089 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8090 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8091 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8092
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008093http_auth(<userlist>)
8094http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008095 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8096 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8097 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8098 of specified groups.
8099
8100 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8101
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008102http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008103 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8104 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8105 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8106 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008108method <string>
8109 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8110 already check for most common methods.
8111
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008112path <string>
8113 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8114 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8115 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8116
8117path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008118 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8119 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008121path_dir <string>
8122 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8123 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8124 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8125 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8126
8127path_dom <string>
8128 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8129 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8130 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008132path_end <string>
8133 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8134 control file name extension.
8135
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008136path_len <integer>
8137 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8138 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008140path_reg <regex>
8141 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8142 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8143 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008145path_sub <string>
8146 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8147 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8148 "path_dir".
8149
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008150payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8151 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8152 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8153 strings.
8154
8155payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8156 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8157 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8158 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8159 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8160 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8161
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008162req_ver <string>
8163 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8164 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8165
8166status <integer>
8167 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8168 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8169 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008171url <string>
8172 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
8173 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
8174
8175url_beg <string>
8176 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
8177 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
8178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008179url_dir <string>
8180 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8181 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8182 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8183 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8184
8185url_dom <string>
8186 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8187 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8188 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8189
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008190url_end <string>
8191 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8192 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008193
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008194url_ip <address>
8195 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8196 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8197 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008198
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008199url_len <integer>
8200 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8201 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8202
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008203url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008204 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8205 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008206 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008207 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008208
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008209url_reg <regex>
8210 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8211 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8212 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008213
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008214url_sub <string>
8215 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8216 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008217
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008218urlp(<name>) <string>
8219 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8220 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8221
8222 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8223 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8224
8225urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8226 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8227 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8228 protocol scheme.
8229
8230urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8231 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8232 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8233 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8234 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8235
8236urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8237 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8238 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8239 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8240 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8241
8242urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8243 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8244
8245urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008246 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8247 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008248
8249urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8250 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8251 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8252
8253urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8254 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8255 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8256 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8257 "urlp_" criteria.
8258
8259urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8260 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8261 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8262 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8263
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082657.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8266---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008268Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8269every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008270order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008272ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8273---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008274FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008275HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008276HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8277HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008278HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8279HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8280HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8281HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8282LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008283METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8284METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8285METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8286METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8287METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8288METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008289RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008290REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008291TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008292WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8293---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008294
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082967.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8297----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008299Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8300combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008302 - AND (implicit)
8303 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8304 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008306A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008308 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008310Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8311indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008313For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8314"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8315requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8316is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008318 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8319 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8320 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8321 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008323To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8324and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008326 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8327 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8328 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8329 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008331 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8332 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8333 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8334 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008335
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008336It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8337expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8338be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8339the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8340
8341 The following rule :
8342
8343 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8344 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8345
8346 Can also be written that way :
8347
8348 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8349
8350It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8351to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8352simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8353sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8354good use is the following :
8355
8356 With named ACLs :
8357
8358 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8359 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8360 monitor fail if site_dead
8361
8362 With anonymous ACLs :
8363
8364 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008366See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008367
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008368
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010083697.8. Pattern extraction
8370-----------------------
8371
8372The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8373response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8374for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8375
8376All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8377"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8378begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8379arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8380much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8381equivalent used in ACLs.
8382
8383The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8384
8385 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008386 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8387 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8388 according to RFC 4291.
8389
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008390 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8391 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8392 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008393 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8394 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8395 according to RFC 4291.
8396
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008397 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8398 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8399 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8400 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8401 type integer and only works with such tables.
8402
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008403 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8404 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8405 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8406 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8407 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8408 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8409 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008410 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008411
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008412 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008413 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8414 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8415 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8416 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008417
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008418 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008419 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8420 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8421 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8422 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8423 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8424 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8425 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8426 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008427
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008428 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8429 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8430 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8431 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8432
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008433 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008434 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8435 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8436 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8437 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8438 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008439
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008440 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008441 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8442 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8443 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8444 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008445
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008446 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8447 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8448 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8449 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8450 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8451 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8452 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008453
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008454 Example :
8455 listen tse-farm
8456 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8457 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8458 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8459 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8460 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8461 persist rdp-cookie
8462 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8463 # This is only useful makes sense if
8464 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8465 stick-table type string size 204800
8466 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8467 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8468 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008469
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008470 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8471 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008472
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008473 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008474 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008475 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8476 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8477 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8478 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8479 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8480 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008481
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008482 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008483
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008484 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008485 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8486 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8487 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8488
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008489 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8490 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8491 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8492 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8493 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008494
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008495 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008496
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008497
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008498The currently available list of transformations include :
8499
8500 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8501 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8502 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8503
8504 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8505 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8506 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8507
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008508 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008509 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8510 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8511 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8512 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8513
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085158. Logging
8516----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008518One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8519provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8520very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8521provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8522state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008523to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008524headers.
8525
8526In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8527about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8528send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8529
8530 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8531 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8532 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8533 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8534 at the termination.
8535
8536The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8537allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8538as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8539while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8540real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8541delay.
8542
8543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085448.1. Log levels
8545---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008546
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008547TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008548source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008549HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8550in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8551track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8552syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8553about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008554
8555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085568.2. Log formats
8557----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008558
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008559HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008560and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8561slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8562options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008563
8564 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8565 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8566 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8567 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8568 extents.
8569
8570 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8571 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8572 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8573 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8574 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8575
8576 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8577 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8578 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8579 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8580 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8581
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008582 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8583 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8584 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8585 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8586
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008587 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8588
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008589Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8590specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8591field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8592servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8593always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8594identifier.
8595
8596Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8597 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8598 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8599 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8600 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8601
8602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086038.2.1. Default log format
8604-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008605
8606This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8607as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8608format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8609
8610 Example :
8611 listen www
8612 mode http
8613 log global
8614 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8615
8616 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8617 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8618 (www/HTTP)
8619
8620 Field Format Extract from the example above
8621 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8622 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8623 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8624 4 'to' to
8625 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8626 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8627
8628Detailed fields description :
8629 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8630 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8631 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8632 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8633 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8634 and processed the connection.
8635 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8636
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008637In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8638"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8639connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8640
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008641It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8642will eventually disappear.
8643
8644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086458.2.2. TCP log format
8646---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008647
8648The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8649is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8650information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8651counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8652emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8653environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8654the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8655sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008656specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8657not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8658fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8659marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008660
8661 Example :
8662 frontend fnt
8663 mode tcp
8664 option tcplog
8665 log global
8666 default_backend bck
8667
8668 backend bck
8669 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8670
8671 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8672 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8673 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8674
8675 Field Format Extract from the example above
8676 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8677 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8678 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8679 4 frontend_name fnt
8680 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8681 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8682 7 bytes_read* 212
8683 8 termination_state --
8684 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8685 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8686
8687Detailed fields description :
8688 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008689 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8690 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8691 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8692 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8693 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008694
8695 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008696 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8697 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8698 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008699
8700 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8701 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8702 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8703 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8704
8705 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8706 and processed the connection.
8707
8708 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8709 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8710 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8711 applications.
8712
8713 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8714 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8715 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8716 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8717 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8718
8719 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8720 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8721 See "Timers" below for more details.
8722
8723 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8724 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8725 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8726 "Timers" below for more details.
8727
8728 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8729 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8730 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8731 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8732 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8733 details.
8734
8735 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8736 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8737 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8738 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8739 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8740
8741 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8742 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8743 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8744 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8745 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8746 for more details.
8747
8748 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8749 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8750 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8751 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8752 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008753 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008754
8755 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8756 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8757 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8758 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8759 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8760 caused by a denial of service attack.
8761
8762 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8763 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8764 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8765 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8766 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8767 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8768 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8769 denial of service attack.
8770
8771 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8772 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8773 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8774 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8775 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8776 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8777 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8778 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8779 be processed than on other servers.
8780
8781 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8782 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8783 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8784 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8785 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8786 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8787 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8788 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8789 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8790 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8791 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8792 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8793 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8794
8795 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8796 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8797 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8798 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8799 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8800 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8801 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8802 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8803
8804 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8805 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8806 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8807 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8808 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8809 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8810 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8811 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8812 occurs.
8813
8814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088158.2.3. HTTP log format
8816----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008817
8818The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8819is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8820the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8821are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8822emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8823generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8824"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8825which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008826frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8827is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008828
8829Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8830slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8831with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8832
8833 Example :
8834 frontend http-in
8835 mode http
8836 option httplog
8837 log global
8838 default_backend bck
8839
8840 backend static
8841 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8842
8843 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8844 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8845 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008846 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008847
8848 Field Format Extract from the example above
8849 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8850 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8851 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8852 4 frontend_name http-in
8853 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8854 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8855 7 status_code 200
8856 8 bytes_read* 2750
8857 9 captured_request_cookie -
8858 10 captured_response_cookie -
8859 11 termination_state ----
8860 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8861 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8862 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8863 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8864 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008866
8867Detailed fields description :
8868 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008869 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8870 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8871 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8872 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8873 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008874
8875 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008876 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8877 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8878 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008879
8880 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8881 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8882 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8883 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8884 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8885
8886 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8887 and processed the connection.
8888
8889 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8890 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8891 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8892
8893 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8894 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8895 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8896 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8897 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8898 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8899
8900 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8901 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8902 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8903 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8904 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8905 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8906
8907 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8908 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8909 See "Timers" below for more details.
8910
8911 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8912 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8913 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8914 below for more details.
8915
8916 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8917 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8918 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8919 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8920 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8921 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8922 for more details.
8923
8924 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8925 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8926 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8927 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8928 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8929 details.
8930
8931 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8932 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8933 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8934
8935 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8936 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8937 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8938 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8939 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8940 overflowing.
8941
8942 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8943 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8944 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8945 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8946 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8947 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8948 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8949 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8950
8951 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8952 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8953 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8954 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8955 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8956 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8957 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8958 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8959
8960 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8961 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8962 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8963 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8964 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8965 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8966 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8967
8968 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8969 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8970 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8971 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8972 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008974 system.
8975
8976 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8977 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8978 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8979 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8980 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8981 caused by a denial of service attack.
8982
8983 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8984 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8985 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8986 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8987 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8988 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8989 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8990 denial of service attack.
8991
8992 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8993 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8994 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8995 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8996 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8997 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8998 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8999 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9000 processed than on other servers.
9001
9002 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9003 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9004 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9005 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9006 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9007 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9008 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9009 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9010 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9011 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9012 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9013 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9014 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9015
9016 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9017 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9018 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9019 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9020 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9021 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9022 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9023 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9024
9025 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9026 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9027 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9028 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9029 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9030 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9031 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9032 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9033 occurs.
9034
9035 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9036 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9037 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9038 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9039 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9040 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9041 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9042 cookies" below for more details.
9043
9044 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9045 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9046 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9047 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9048 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9049 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9050 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9051 and cookies" below for more details.
9052
9053 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9054 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9055 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9056 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9057 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9058 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9059 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9060 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9061
9062
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020090638.2.4. Custom log format
9064------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009065
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009066The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9067mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009068
9069HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9070Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9071separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9072prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9073
9074Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9075variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9076string formats ("Q").
9077
9078Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9079HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9080
9081Flags are :
9082 * Q: quote a string
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009083 * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009084
9085 Example:
9086
9087 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9088 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9089
9090At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9091
9092 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009093 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009094
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009095the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009096
9097 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009098 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009099 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9100
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009101and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9102
9103 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9104 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9105
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009106Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9107
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009108 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9109 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9110 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9111 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9112 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9113 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009114 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009115 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009116 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009117 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009118 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9119 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9120 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009121 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009122 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9123 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9124 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009125 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9126 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9127 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009128 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009129 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9130 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9131 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9132 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9133 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9134 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9135 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009136 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009137 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9138 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9139 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9140 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9141 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9142 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9143 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9144 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009145 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009146 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9147 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9148 | | %s | server_name | string |
9149 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9150 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9151 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009152 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009153 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009154 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009155 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009156
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009157*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091598.3. Advanced logging options
9160-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009161
9162Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9163just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9164options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9165for more information about their usage.
9166
9167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9169------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009170
9171It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9172haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9173commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9174monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9175ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9176
9177 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9178 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9179 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9180 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9181
9182 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9183 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9184 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9185 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9186 such as other load-balancers.
9187
9188 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9189 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9190 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9191
9192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9194----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009195
9196The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9197what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9198or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9199"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9200just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9201log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9202after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9203is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9204with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9205with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9206
9207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9209------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009210
9211Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9212for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9213"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9214retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9215raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9216a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9217file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9218you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9219"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9220
9221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9223--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009224
9225Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9226multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9227them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9228"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9229logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9230error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9231and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9232too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9233useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9234alternative.
9235
9236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092378.4. Timing events
9238------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009239
9240Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9241reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9242the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9243frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9244mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9245
9246 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9247 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9248 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9249 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9250 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9251
9252 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9253 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9254 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9255 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9256 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9257
9258 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9259 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9260 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9261 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9262 connection never established.
9263
9264 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9265 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9266 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9267 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9268 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9269 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9270 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9271 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9272 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9273 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9274 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9275
9276 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9277 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9278 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9279 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9280 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9281
9282 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9283
9284 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9285 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9286 negative.
9287
9288These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9289protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9290that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009291due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009292close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9293session has been aborted on timeout.
9294
9295Most common cases :
9296
9297 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9298 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9299 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9300 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9301 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9302 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9303 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9304 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9305 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009306 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9307 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9308 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009309
9310 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9311 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9312 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9313 of ms on remote networks.
9314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009315 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9316 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9317 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009318
9319 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9320 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9321 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9322 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9323 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9324 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9325 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9326 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9327 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9328 to the server until another one is released.
9329
9330Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9331
9332 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9333 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9334 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9335
9336 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9337 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9338 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9339
9340 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9341 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9342 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9343 flags.
9344
9345 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9346 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9347 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9348 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9349 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9350 the client connection was maintained open.
9351
9352 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9353 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9354 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9355 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9356
9357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093588.5. Session state at disconnection
9359-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009360
9361TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9362"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
93632-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9364each of which has a special meaning :
9365
9366 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9367 session to terminate :
9368
9369 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9370
9371 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9372 server explicitly refused it.
9373
9374 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9375 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9376 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9377 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9378 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9379 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9380
9381 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9382 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9383 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9384 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9385 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9386
9387 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9388 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9389 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9390 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9391 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9392
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009393 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9394 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9395
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009396 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9397
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009398 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9399 send or receive data.
9400
9401 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9402 send or receive data.
9403
9404 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9405 with nothing left in the buffers.
9406
9407 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9408
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009409 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009410 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9411
9412 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9413 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9414 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9415 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9416 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9417
9418 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9419 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9420
9421 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9422 server (HTTP only).
9423
9424 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9425
9426 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9427 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9428 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9429
9430 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9431 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9432 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9433
9434 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9435
9436 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9437 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9438
9439 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9440 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9441 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9442
9443 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9444 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009445 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9446 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009447
9448 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9449 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9450 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9451 another server.
9452
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009453 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009454 server.
9455
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009456 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9457 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9458 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9459 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9460
9461 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9462 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9463 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9464 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9465
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009466 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9467 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9468 "use-server" rule).
9469
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009470 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9471
9472 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9473 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9474
9475 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9476
9477 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9478 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9479 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9480
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009481 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9482 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9483 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9484 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9485 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9486
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009487 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9488
9489 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9490 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9491
9492 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9493
9494 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9495
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009496The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9497was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009498helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9499starvation, attacks, etc...
9500
9501The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9502alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9503easier finding and understanding.
9504
9505 Flags Reason
9506
9507 -- Normal termination.
9508
9509 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9510 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9511 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9512 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9513
9514 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9515 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9516 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9517 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9518 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9519 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009520
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009521 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9522 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009523 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009524
9525 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9526 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9527 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9528
9529 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9530 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9531 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9532 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9533 the server takes too long to respond.
9534
9535 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9536 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9537 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9538 long a time to respond.
9539
9540 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9541 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9542 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9543 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9544 and the client.
9545
9546 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9547 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9548 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9549 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9550 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9551 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9552
9553 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9554 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009555 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9556 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9557 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9558 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009560 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009561 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9562 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9563 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9564 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9565 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9566
9567 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9568 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9569 503 or 504 here.
9570
9571 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9572 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9573 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9574 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9575 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9576
9577 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9578 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009579 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009580 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9581 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9582
9583 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9584 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9585 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9586 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9587 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9588 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9589 between haproxy and the server.
9590
9591 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9592 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9593 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9594 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9595 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9596 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9597 solution is to fix the application.
9598
9599 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9600 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9601 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9602 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9603 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9604 external attacks.
9605
9606 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9607 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009608 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009609 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9610 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9611
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009612 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9613 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9614 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9615 the client.
9616
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009617 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9618 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9619 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9620 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009621 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9622 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9623 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9624 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9625 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009626
9627 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9628 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9629 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9630 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9631
9632 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9633 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9634 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9635 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9636
9637 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9638 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9639 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9640 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9641
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009642The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9643persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9644important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9645re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9646
9647 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9648
9649 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9650 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9651 set on a GET request.
9652
9653 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9654 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9655 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9656 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9657
9658 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9659 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9660 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9661
9662 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9663 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9664 already got a cookie.
9665
9666 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9667 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9668 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9669 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9670 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9671
9672 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9673 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9674 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9675
9676 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9677 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9678 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9679
9680 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9681 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9682
9683 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9684 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9685 then advertised in the response.
9686
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096888.6. Non-printable characters
9689-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009690
9691In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9692consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9693converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9694prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9695being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9696escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9697is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9698'}' when logging headers.
9699
9700Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9701issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9702containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9703
9704Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9705the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9706performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9707
9708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9710---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009711
9712Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9713achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009714section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009715cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9716the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9717the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009718locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009719not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9720user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9721a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9722wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9723
9724 Examples :
9725 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9726 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9727
9728 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9729 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9730
9731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097328.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9733---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009734
9735Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9736proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9737the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9738server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9739
9740Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9741response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009742section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009743
9744It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009745time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9746appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009747are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9748and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9749follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9750request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9751in the logs.
9752
9753 Example :
9754 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9755 listen proxy-out
9756 mode http
9757 option httplog
9758 option logasap
9759 log global
9760 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9761
9762 # log the name of the virtual server
9763 capture request header Host len 20
9764
9765 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9766 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9767
9768 # log the beginning of the referrer
9769 capture request header Referer len 20
9770
9771 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9772 capture response header Server len 20
9773
9774 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9775 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9776
9777 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9778 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9779
9780 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9781 capture response header Via len 20
9782
9783 # log the URL location during a redirection
9784 capture response header Location len 20
9785
9786 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9787 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9788 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9789 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9790 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9791
9792 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9793 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9794 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9795 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009796 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009797
9798 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9799 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9800 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9801 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9802 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009803 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009804
9805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098068.9. Examples of logs
9807---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009808
9809These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9810them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9811reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9812
9813 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9814 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9815 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9816
9817 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9818 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9819
9820 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9821 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9822 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9823
9824 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9825 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9826
9827 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9828 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9829 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9830
9831 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009832 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009833 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9834 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9835
9836 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9837 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9838 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9839
9840 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9841 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009842 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009843 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9844 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9845 to return the 502 and not the server.
9846
9847 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009848 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009849
9850 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9851 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9852 Nothing was sent to any server.
9853
9854 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9855 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9856
9857 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9858 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9859 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9860 send a 408 return code to the client.
9861
9862 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9863 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9864
9865 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9866 5 seconds ("c----").
9867
9868 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9869 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009870 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009871
9872 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009873 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009874 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9875 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9876 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9877 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9878 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009879
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098819. Statistics and monitoring
9882----------------------------
9883
9884It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9885mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9886CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9887Unix socket.
9888
9889
98909.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009891---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009892
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009893The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9894page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009896 0. pxname: proxy name
9897 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9898 for server)
9899 2. qcur: current queued requests
9900 3. qmax: max queued requests
9901 4. scur: current sessions
9902 5. smax: max sessions
9903 6. slim: sessions limit
9904 7. stot: total sessions
9905 8. bin: bytes in
9906 9. bout: bytes out
9907 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009908 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009909 12. ereq: request errors
9910 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009911 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009912 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9913 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009914 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009915 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9916 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9917 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9918 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9919 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9920 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9921 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9922 25. qlimit: queue limit
9923 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9924 27. iid: unique proxy id
9925 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9926 29. throttle: warm up status
9927 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9928 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009929 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009930 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9931 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9932 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009933 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009934 UNK -> unknown
9935 INI -> initializing
9936 SOCKERR -> socket error
9937 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9938 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9939 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9940 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9941 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9942 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9943 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9944 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9945 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9946 disable-on-404
9947 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9948 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9949 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009950 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9951 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009952 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9953 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9954 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9955 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9956 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9957 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009958 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9959 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9960 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9961 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009962 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9963 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099669.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009967-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009968
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009969The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009970must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9971is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9972a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9973risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9974followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9975given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9976then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9977to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009978
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009979It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9980on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9981own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009983clear counters
9984 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9985 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9986 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9987 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9988 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9989
9990clear counters all
9991 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9992 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9993 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9994
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009995clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9996 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9997
9998 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9999 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10000 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10001 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10002 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10003 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10004
10005 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10006
10007 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10008 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10009 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10010 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10011 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10012 the ACLs :
10013
10014 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10015 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10016 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10017 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10018 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10019 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10020
10021 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010022 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10023 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010024
10025 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010026 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010027 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010028 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10029 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10030 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10031 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010032
10033 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10034
10035 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010036 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010037 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10038 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010039 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10040 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10041 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010042
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010043disable frontend <frontend>
10044 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10045 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10046 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10047 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10048 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10049 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10050 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10051 on the stats page.
10052
10053 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10054 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10055
10056 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10057 level "admin".
10058
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010059disable server <backend>/<server>
10060 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10061 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10062 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10063 during the maintenance.
10064
10065 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10066 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10067
10068 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010069 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010070
10071 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10072 level "admin".
10073
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010074enable frontend <frontend>
10075 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10076 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10077 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10078 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10079 which was disabled.
10080
10081 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10082 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10083
10084 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10085 level "admin".
10086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087enable server <backend>/<server>
10088 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10089 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10090
10091 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010092 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010093
10094 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10095 level "admin".
10096
10097get weight <backend>/<server>
10098 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10099 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10100 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10101 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10102 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010103 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010104
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010105help
10106 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10107 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010108
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010109prompt
10110 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10111 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10112 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10113 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10114 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10115 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10116 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10117 command.
10118
10119quit
10120 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010121
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010122set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10123 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10124 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10125 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10126 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10127 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10128 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10129 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10130
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010131set maxconn global <maxconn>
10132 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10133 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10134 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10135 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10136 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10137 setting.
10138
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010139set rate-limit connections global <value>
10140 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10141 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10142 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10143 is passed in number of connections per second.
10144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010145set timeout cli <delay>
10146 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10147 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10148 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10149
10150set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10151 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10152 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10153 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10154 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10155 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10156 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10157 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10158 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10159 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10160 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10161 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10162 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10163 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010164 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010165
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010166show errors [<iid>]
10167 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10168 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010169 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10170 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10171 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010172
10173 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10174 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10175 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10176 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10177 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10178 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10179 are reported too.
10180
10181 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10182 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10183 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10184 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10185 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10186 code.
10187
10188 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10189 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10190 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10191 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10192 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10193 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10194 line.
10195
10196 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010197 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10198 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010199 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10200 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10201
10202 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10203 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10204 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10205 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10206 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10207 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10208 00204+ minal\r\n
10209 00211 \r\n
10210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010211 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010212 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10213 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10214 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10215 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10216 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10217 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010218
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010219show info
10220 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10221
10222show sess
10223 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010224 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10225 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10226
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010227show sess <id>
10228 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10229 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10230 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10231 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10232 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10233 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010234
10235show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10236 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10237 possible to dump only selected items :
10238 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10239 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10240 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10241 for example:
10242 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10243 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10244 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10245
10246 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010247 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10248 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010249 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10250 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10251 Nbproc: 1
10252 Process_num: 1
10253 (...)
10254
10255 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10256 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10257 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10258 (...)
10259 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10260
10261 $
10262
10263 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10264 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10265 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10266 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010267 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010268
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010269show table
10270 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10271 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10272 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10273 entries currently in use.
10274
10275 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010276 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010277 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10278 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010279
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010280show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010281 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10282 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10283 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010284 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10285
10286 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10287 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10288 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10289 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10290 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10291
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010292 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10293 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10294 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10295 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10296 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10297 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10298
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010299
10300 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010301 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10302 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010303
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010304 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010305 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010306 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010307 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10308 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10309 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10310 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010311
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010312 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010313 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010314 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10315 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010316
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010317 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10318 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010319 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010320 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10321 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010322
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010323 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10324 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010325 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010326 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10327 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10328
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010329 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10330 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10331 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10332 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10333 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10334
10335 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10336 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10337 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010338 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10339 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010340 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10341 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010342
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010343shutdown frontend <frontend>
10344 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10345 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10346 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10347 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10348 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10349 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10350 once it is terminated.
10351
10352 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10353 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10354
10355 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10356 level "admin".
10357
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010358shutdown session <id>
10359 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10360 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10361 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10362 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10363 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10364 flag in the logs.
10365
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010366shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10367 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10368 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10369 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10370 'K' flag in the logs.
10371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010372/*
10373 * Local variables:
10374 * fill-column: 79
10375 * End:
10376 */